PowerPanel300 PDF
PowerPanel300 PDF
PowerPanel300 PDF
400-ENG
All information contained in this manual is current as of its creation/publication. We reserve the
right to change the contents of this manual without warning. The information contained herein is
believed to be accurate as of the date of publication; however, Bernecker + Rainer Industrie-
Elektronik Ges.m.b.H. makes no warranty, expressed or implied, with regards to the products or
the documentation contained within this book. In addition, Bernecker + Rainer Industrie-
Elektronik Ges.m.b.H. shall not be liable in the event of incidental or consequential damages in
connection with or resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of these products. The
software names, hardware names, and trademarks used in this manual are registered by the
respective companies.
Chapter 3: Commissioning
Chapter 4: Software
Chapter 6: Accessories
Appendix A
Figure index
Table index
Index
Table of contents
General information
Chapter 1
Chapter 1 • General information
Information:
B&R does its best to keep the printed versions of its user's manuals as current as
possible. However, any newer versions of the User's Manual can always be
downloaded in electronic form (pdf) from the B&R homepage www.br-
automation.com.
1. Manual history
General information
1.60 2008-11-05 - Change to Automation Device Interface (ADI) Control Center on page 481.
Chapter 1
- B&R Key Editor moved from chapter 4 "Software" to chapter "Appendix" on page 545.
- Information for battery lifespan changed in chapter 2 "Technical data".
- Update of Power Panel compact / light devices (4PP420:0571-L05, 4PP420:0571-L45,
4PP420:0571-L25, 4PP420:0571-L65, 4PP420:0571-L35, 4PP420:0571-L75, 4PP420:0571-C05,
4PP420:0571-C45, 4PP420:0571-C25, 4PP420:0571-C65, 4PP420:0571-C35, 4PP420:0571-
C75, 4PP451:0571-L25, 4PP451:0571-L65, 4PP451:0571-L35, 4PP451:0571-L75, 4PP451:0571-
C25, 4PP451:0571-C65, 4PP451:0571-C35, 4PP451:0571-C75, 4PP452:0571-L25,
4PP452:0571-L65, 4PP452:0571-L35, 4PP452:0571-L75, 4PP452:0571-L25, 4PP452:0571-L65,
4PP452:0571-L35, 4PP452:0571-L75).
- Block diagrams updated for PP300 and PP400 on page 385.
- User ID description expanded.
- Temperature/humidity diagrams for PP300 and PP400 updated.
- Topology images changed (design updated).
- Grounding resistance changed to bleeder resistance.
- ADI development kit on page 547 updated.
- Error corrected for the 4PP3xx devices - Devices are not battery buffered.
1.70 2009-01-20 - Technical data corrected for devices: 4PP351.0571-01, 4PP351.0571-35,
4PP352.0571-35, 4PP452.1043-75 - these devices have no touch screen.
- 4PP451.0571-85 device: Contents of delivery and technical data changed-> incorrect display
description.
- 4PP451.1043-75 device: Description and technical data changed for device - it only has 1 aPCI
slot.
- Phantom key information changed.
- Model numbers 5SWWCE.0522-ENG, 5SWWCE.0622-ENG, 5SWWCE.0822-ENG,
5SWWXP.0422-ENG added.
- Section 2.7 "Environmentally-friendly disposal" in chapter 1 "General information" added.
- Temperature and humidity diagrams changed.
- Contents of delivery for USB flash drives removed.
- Mounting orientation -45° and +45° revised.
1.80 2009-04-01 - Display properties corrected for the device 4PP351.0571-35.
- Number of function keys and soft keys corrected for the device 4PP352.0571-35.
- Section 4.2 "Differences between the Windows CE 5.0 versions (Pro - PropPlus)" updated.
- Section 4.4 "Windows CE 6.0 features" updated.
- Displays changed on the devices 4PP320.0571-35, 4PP351.0571-35, 4PP352.0571-35,
4PP420.0571-75, 4PP420.0571-B5, 4PP451.0571-75, 4PP451.0571-B5, 4PP452.0571-75,
4PP452.0571-B5 and 5PP320.0571-39 - changes made to the technical data of the displays.
- Section 7.4 "Creating a bootable USB flash drive", changed on page 479.
- B&R CompactFlash card added.
- Technical data for Silicon Systems CFs revised.
2. Safety guidelines
General information
Chapter 1
2.1 Intended use
Programmable logic controllers (PLCs), operating and monitoring devices (industrial PCs, Power
Panels, Mobile Panels, etc.), and B&R uninterruptible power supplies have been designed,
developed, and manufactured for conventional use in industry. They were not designed,
developed, and manufactured for any use involving serious risks or hazards that could lead to
death, injury, serious physical damage, or loss of any kind without the implementation of
exceptionally stringent safety precautions. In particular, such risks and hazards include the use
of these devices to monitor nuclear reactions in nuclear power plants, as well as flight control
systems, flight safety, the control of mass transit systems, medical life support systems and the
control of weapons systems.
Electrical components that are vulnerable to electrostatic discharge (ESD) must be handled
accordingly.
2.2.1 Packaging
• Any persons handling electrical components or devices that will be installed in the
electrical components must be grounded.
• Components can only be touched on the small sides or on the front plate.
• Components should always be stored in a suitable medium (ESD packaging, conductive
foam, etc.).
Metallic surfaces are not suitable storage surfaces!
Individual components
• ESD protective measures for individual components are thoroughly integrated at B&R
(conductive floors, footwear, arm bands, etc.).
The increased ESD protective measures for individual components are not necessary for our
customers for handling B&R products.
Electronic devices are generally not failsafe. In the event of a failure on the programmable
control system, operating or monitoring device, or uninterruptible power supply, the user is
responsible for ensuring that other devices that may be connected, e.g. motors, are in a secure
state.
Both when using programmable logic controllers and when using operating and monitoring
devices as control systems in conjunction with a soft PLC (e.g. B&R Automation Runtime or
comparable products) or a slot PLC (e.g. B&R LS251 or comparable products), the safety
precautions applying to industrial control systems (e.g. the provision of safety devices such as
emergency stop circuits, etc.) must be observed in accordance with applicable national and
international regulations. The same applies for all other devices connected to the system, such
as drives.
All tasks such as installation, commissioning, and maintenance are only permitted to be carried
out by qualified personnel. Qualified personnel are persons who are familiar with the transport,
mounting, installation, commissioning, and operation of the product and who have the
appropriate qualifications (e.g. IEC 60364). National accident prevention guidelines must be
followed.
The safety guidelines, connection descriptions (rating plate and documentation) and limit values
listed in the technical data must be read carefully and must be observed before installation and
commissioning.
During transport and storage, devices must be protected from excessive stress (mechanical
load, temperature, humidity, aggressive atmospheres, etc.).
2.5 Installation
General information
Chapter 1
• Installation must take place according to the documentation, using suitable equipment
and tools.
• Devices must be installed without voltage applied and by qualified personnel.
• General safety regulations and nationally applicable accident prevention guidelines must
be observed.
• Electrical installation must be carried out according to the relevant guidelines (e.g. line
cross section, fuse, protective ground connection).
2.6 Operation
Before turning on the programmable logic controller, the operating and monitoring devices and
the uninterruptible power supply, ensure that the housing is properly grounded (PE rail). The
ground connection must be established when testing the operating and monitoring devices or
the uninterruptible power supply, even when operating them for only a short time.
Before turning the device on, make sure that all parts with voltage applied are securely covered.
During operation, all covers must remain closed.
Use of operating and monitoring devices (e.g. industrial PCs, power panels, mobile panels, etc.)
and uninterruptible power supplies in very dusty environments should be avoided. Dust
collection on the devices influences their function and, especially in systems with active cooling
(fans), sufficient cooling cannot be guaranteed.
The presence of aggressive gases in the environment can also lead to malfunctions. When
combined with high temperature and humidity, aggressive gases - e.g. with sulfur, nitrogen and
chlorine components - start chemical processes that can damage electronic components very
quickly. Signs of the presence of aggressive gases are blackened copper surfaces and cable
ends on existing installations.
For operation in dusty or humid conditions, correctly installed (cutout installation) operating and
monitoring devices like Automation Panel or Power Panel are protected on the front side. The
rear side of all devices must be protected from dust and humidity and must be cleaned at suitable
intervals.
The system is subject to potential danger each time data is exchanged or software is installed
from a data medium (e.g. diskette, CD-ROM, USB flash drive, etc.), a network connection, or the
Internet. The user is responsible for assessing these dangers, implementing preventative
measures such as virus protection programs, firewalls, etc. and obtaining software from reliable
sources.
All B&R programmable controllers, operating and monitoring devices, and uninterruptible power
supplies are designed to inflict as little harm on the environment as possible.
. Component Disposal
Programmable logic controllers Electronics recycling
Operating and monitoring devices
Uninterruptible power supply
Cables
Cardboard box / paper packaging Paper / cardboard recycling
Plastic packaging Plastic recycling
General information
Chapter 1
The safety notices in this manual are organized as follows:
4. Guidelines
5. Model numbers
General information
Chapter 1
Model number Short description Note
4PP320.0571-01 Power Panel PP320 5.7" QVGA, touch screen See page 114
5.7" QVGA monochrome LC display with touch screen (resistive), 128 MB SDRAM;
CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65 protection
(front side); 24 VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP320.0571-35 Power Panel PP320 5.7" QVGA, touch screen See page 120
5.7" QVGA color TFT display with touch screen (resistive); 128 MB SDRAM; CompactFlash
slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC
(Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP320.1043-31 Power Panel PP320 10.4" VGA, touch screen See page 126
10.4" VGA color TFT display with touch screen (resistive); 128 MB SDRAM; CompactFlash
slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC
(Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP320.1505-31 Power Panel PP320 15" XGA, touch screen See page 132
15" XGA color TFT display with touch screen (resistive); 128 MB SDRAM; CompactFlash slot
(type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC
(Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP351.0571-01 Power Panel PP351 5.7" QVGA See page 138
5.7" QVGA monochrome LC display; 6 softkeys, 16 function keys and 20 system keys; 128
MB SDRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65
protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91
separately.)
4PP351.0571-35 Power Panel PP351 5.7" QVGA See page 144
5.7" QVGA color TFT display; 6 softkeys, 16 function keys and 20 system keys; 128 MB
SDRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65
protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91
separately.)
4PP352.0571-35 Power Panel PP351 5.7" QVGA See page 150
5.7" QVGA color TFT display; 20 function keys and 20 system keys; 128 MB SDRAM;
CompactFlash slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS 232, 2xUSB; metal housing, IP65 protection
(front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP381.1043-31 Power Panel PP381 10.4" VGA, touch screen See page 156
10.4" VGA TFT color display with touch screen (resistive); 10 softkeys, 28 function keys and
20
system keys, 128 MB SDRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24 VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage
clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
General information
4PP420.1505-B5 Power Panel PP420 15" XGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen See page 235
Chapter 1
15" XGA color TFT display with touch screen (resistive), 2 aPCI slots; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM, CompactFlash slot (type I), ETH 10/100, RS232, 2xUSB; battery; metal
housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24 VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp
0TB103.91 separately.)*
4PP451.0571-45 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 241
5.7" QVGA monochrome LC display; 6 softkeys; 16 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot;
128 MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or
cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP451.0571-65 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 247
5.7" QVGA color LC display; 6 softkeys; 16 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot; 128 MB
SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB; battery; Cancelled since
metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage 4/2008
clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP451.0571-75 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 253
5.7" QVGA color TFT display; 6 softkeys; 16 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot; 128
MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or
cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP451.0571-85 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 2 aPCI, keys See page 260
5.7" QVGA monochrome LC display; 6 softkeys; 16 function and 20 system keys; 2 aPCI
slots; 128 MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232;
2xUSB; battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp
0TB103.9 or cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately).
4PP451.0571-B5 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 2 aPCI, keys See page 266
5.7" QVGA color TFT display; 6 softkeys; 16 function and 20 system keys; 2 aPCI slot; 128
MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or
cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP451.1043-75 Power Panel PP451 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 273
10.4" VGA color TFT display; 10 softkeys; 28 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot; 128
MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or
cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP451.1043-B5 Power Panel PP451 10.4" VGA, 2 aPCI, keys See page 279
10.4" VGA color TFT display; 10 softkeys; 28 function and 20 system keys; 2 aPCI slot; 128
MB SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB;
battery; metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or
cage clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP452.0571-45 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 285
5.7" QVGA monochrome LC display; 20 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot; 128 MB
SDRAM; 512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB; battery;
metal housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage
clamp 0TB103.91 separately.)
4PP452.0571-65 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys See page 291
5.7" QVGA color LC display; 20 function and 20 system keys; 1 aPCI slot; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; CompactFlash slot (type I); ETH 10/100; RS232; 2xUSB; battery; metal Cancelled since
housing, IP65 protection (front side); 24VDC (Order screw clamp 0TB103.9 or cage clamp 4/2008
0TB103.91 separately.)
General information
Chapter 1
Model number Short description Note
4PP420:0571-L05 Power Panel PP420 light LCD monochrome, CAN, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light CAN; 5.7'' QVGA LCD monochrome; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-L45 Power Panel PP420 light LCD monochrome, X2X, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light X2X; 5.7'' QVGA LCD monochrome; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-L25 Power Panel PP420 light LCD color, CAN, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light CAN; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-L65 Power Panel PP420 light LCD color, X2X, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light X2X; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-L35 Power Panel PP420 light TFT color, CAN, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light CAN; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-L75 Power Panel PP420 light TFT color, X2X, touch screen See page 359
Set Power Panel PP420 light X2X; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP420:0571-C05 Power Panel PP420 compact LCD monochrome, CAN, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact CAN; 5.7'' QVGA LCD monochrome; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP420:0571-C45 Power Panel PP420 compact LCD monochrome, X2X, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact X2X; 5.7'' QVGA LCD monochrome; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP420:0571-C25 Power Panel PP420 compact LCD color, CAN, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact CAN; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP420:0571-C65 Power Panel PP420 compact LCD color, X2X, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact X2X; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP420:0571-C35 Power Panel PP420 compact TFT color, CAN, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact CAN; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP420:0571-C75 Power Panel PP420 compact TFT color, X2X, touch screen See page 364
Set Power Panel PP420 compact X2X; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM; ETH 10/100.
4PP451:0571-L25 Power Panel PP451 light LCD color, CAN, keys See page 369
Set Power Panel PP451 light CAN; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP451:0571-L65 Power Panel PP451 light LCD color, X2X, keys See page 369
Set Power Panel PP451 light X2X; 5.7'' QVGA LCD color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP451:0571-L35 Power Panel PP451 light TFT color, CAN, keys See page 369
Set Power Panel PP451 light CAN; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
4PP451:0571-L75 Power Panel PP451 light TFT color, X2X, keys See page 369
Set Power Panel PP451 light X2X; 5.7'' QVGA TFT color; 128 MB SDRAM;
512 KB SRAM.
Table 7: Model number overview - Power Panel light / compact devices (Forts.)
5.5 Software
General information
5SWWCE.0821-ENG WinCE6.0 Pro PP300 LX800 See page 471
Chapter 1
Microsoft Windows CE 6.0 Professional, English, including license; for PP300 BIOS devices
5PP320.0571-29, 5PP320.0571-39, 5PP320.0573-39, 5PP320.1043-39, 5PP320.1214-39,
5PP320.1505-39, order CompactFlash separately (at least 128 MB).
5SWWXP.0421-ENG WinXPe FP2007 PP300 LX800 See page 475
Microsoft Windows XP embedded, English, Feature Pack 2007; for PP300 BIOS devices
5PP320.0571-29, 5PP320.0571-39, 5PP320.0573-39, 5PP320.1043-39, 5PP320.1214-39,
5PP320.1505-39, order CompactFlash separately (at least 512 MB). Only delivered with a
new Power Panel.
5SWWCE.0522-ENG WinCE5.0 Pro PP400 LX800 See page 471
Microsoft Windows CE 5.0 Professional, English; for Power Panel 400 BIOS;
Order CompactFlash separately (min.128 MB).
5SWWCE.0622-ENG WinCE5.0 ProPlus PP400 LX800 See page 471
Microsoft Windows CE 5.0 Professional plus, English; for Power Panel 400 BIOS;
Order CompactFlash separately (min. 128 MB).
5SWWCE.0822-ENG WinCE6.0 Pro PP400 LX800 See page 471
Microsoft Windows CE 6.0 Professional, English; for Power Panel 400 BIOS;
Order CompactFlash separately (min. 128 MB).
5SWWXP.0422-ENG WinXPe FP2007 PP400 LX800 See page 475
Microsoft Windows XP Embedded Feature Pack 2007, English; for Power Panel 400;
Order CompactFlash separately (min. 512 MB).
5SWWXP.0721-ENG Windows Embedded Standard 2009 PP300 LX800 See page 477
Microsoft OEM Windows embedded Standard 2009, English; for Power Panel 300; please or-
der CompactFlash separately (minimum 1 GB).
5SWWXP.0722-ENG Windows Embedded Standard 2009 PP400 LX800 See page 477
Microsoft OEM Windows embedded Standard 2009, English; for Power Panel 400; please or-
der CompactFlash separately (minimum 1 GB).
5.6 Accessories
1. General information
Technical data
Chapter 2
The new Power Panel 300/400 generation expands upon B&R's proven Power Panel 100/200
line. With more than twice the computing power, the new generation covers a performance range
that until recently could only be handled by industrial PCs.
For the Power Panel 300 and the Power Panel 400, B&R also implements the proven product
lines of BIOS devices (Power Panel 300) and embedded devices (Power Panel 300 and Power
Panel 400). Power Panel 300 devices can be delivered with the Windows XP embedded and
Windows CE operating systems. They cover the entire range of PC systems, from simple thin
clients and web terminals to full SCADA systems. Power Panel 300 and Power Panel 400
products are designed to automate complete systems. Integrated control functionality and drive
technology act together with modular interfaces for connecting peripheral devices for the
process. Models ranging from 5.7" QVGA to 15" XGA meet all requirements for series machine
manufacturing. There is a new combination of 5.7" diagonal and VGA TFT display. It allows a
great deal of information to be displayed in a small amount of space and images can be shown
is detail. Entries are made either via touch screen or using function keys.
1.1 Features
1.2.1 Electrical
• More powerful processor (Geode LX800 = more than twice the performance)
• 180° rotated power supply plug
• Insyde BIOS
• Power button
Technical data
• ATX compatible power supply
Chapter 2
• USB 2.0 support
• Different network controller
• MTCX controller
• Lower power consumption
1.2.2 Mechanical
127.5
149.1
158.3
168.8
77.2
88.5
104.7
150.9
158.3
168.8
55.5
34.4
42.5
83.9
132
36
0
59
0
The following section provides a description of all interfaces and plugs possible with a
PowerPanel 300 device with BIOS.
The 3-pin socket required for the supply voltage connection is not included in delivery. This can
be ordered from B&R using the model number 0TB103.9 (screw clamps) or 0TB103.91 (cage
clamps).
The pin assignments can be found either in the following table or printed on the Power Panel
plate. The supply voltage is internally protected so that the device cannot be damaged if there is
an overload (fuse replacement necessary) or if the voltage supply is connected incorrectly
(reverse polarity protection - fuse replacement not necessary).
Supply voltage
Protected against reverse polarity
Pin Description
1 +
2 Functional ground
3 2 1
3 -
Accessories
0TB103.9 Plug 24 V 5.08 3-pin screw clamps
0TB103.91 Plug 24 V 5.08 3-pin cage clamps
Ground
Warning!
The pin's connection to the functional ground (pin 2, e.g. switching cabinet) should
be as short as possible. We recommend using the largest possible conductor cross
section on the supply plug.
Next to the supply voltage plug there is a functional grounding clip. The grounding clip (functional
ground) must be connected with a central grounding point on the switching cabinet using a 6.3
mm blade connector via the shortest distance and with as little resistance as possible (e.g.
copper strip, but must be at least 2.5 mm²).
Grounding clip
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 4: Functional grounding clip
The Power Panel is equipped with a PC-compatible serial interface with a 16-byte FIFO buffer.
This non-electrically isolated interface is primarily intended for programming Power Panel
devices using Automation Studio.
The RS232 can also be used as a general interface (e.g. third-party connections, barcode
reader, etc.).
4 DTR
5 GND
6 DSR
7 RTS
8 CTS
9 RI
The Power Panel 300/400 devices have a USB 2.0 (Universal Serial Bus) host controller with
multiple USB ports, two of which are on the outside for easy user access.
Technical data
cable length
Chapter 2
Table 11: USB port
1) The actual value depends on the operating system or diver being used.
2) For safety, every USB port is equipped with a maintenance free "USB current-limiting circuit breaker" (max. 500 mA)
Warning!
Peripheral USB devices can be connected to the USB interfaces. Due to the vast
number of USB devices available on the market, B&R cannot guarantee their
performance. B&R does ensure the performance of all USB devices that they
provide.
Warning!
Because of general PC specifications, this interface should be handled with extreme
care with regard to EMC, location of cables, etc.
Power Panel devices are equipped with 2 hex switches that serve as operating mode switches.
Switch positions 01 to FD are available for any purpose in an application and can be evaluated
by the application program.
Mode/Node switch
SW1 SW2
Switch position
SW1 (x16) SW2 (x1) Function Description
0 0 Service mode Necessary for restoring the default BIOS settings - for more information, see section
"Restoring the default BIOS values" on page 447.
x x None No other switch positions have significance.
Power Panel devices are equipped with a BIOS boot mode switch.
Technical data
Chapter 2
AR
-M
od
e
OS
-M
od
e
Table 14: BIOS boot mode switch positions (based on the image)
Warning!
Carefully use a pointed object to change switch position.
OS mode
• Standard Boot Screen (see section 1 "Power Panel 300 with BIOS" on page 397)
• BIOS Setup can be started by pressing the "DEL" key.
• When the switch is in the "00" position, the setup default values will be restored after
restarting three times.
AR mode
The device will be initialized for Automation Runtime when AR mode is enabled.
• Other boot screen (see section 2 "Power Panel 300/400 with Automation Runtime" on
page 452)
• USB Boot "Enabled" (only in switch position "00")
Power Panels are equipped with two status LEDs that are visible on the outside.
Status LEDs
LED Color Meaning
Green On Supply voltage OK 1x three-color, 1x one-color
The system is in standby mode
Power (S5: soft-off mode or S4:
Red On
hibernate mode - suspend-to-
Technical data
disk)
Chapter 2
Yellow On Can be used as the user wants
(for example, can be turned
User on/off directly using the ADI
Green Off library - only possible in S0
state)
Indicates access to
CF Yellow On CompactFlash drive (read or
write)
Ethernet connection
Controller Intel 82551ER RJ45 twisted pair (10BaseT/100BaseT), female
Cabling S/STP (category 5)
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s 1)
LED On Off
Green 100 MBit/s 10 MBit/s
Orange Link Activity (blinking)
(Ethernet network (Data transfer in
connection progress)
available)
Due to the complete ATX power supply support, the power button serves a number of functions,
which can be configured in BIOS setup.
Power button
Reset button
Warning!
A system reset can cause data to be lost!
Power Panel devices are equipped with a CompactFlash slot that is accessible from the side.
Type I CompactFlash cards are supported.
Ejection lever
Safety latch
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 6: CompactFlash slot
It is possible to secure the CompactFlash slot using the latch provided. By pressing the ejector
(using a pointed object is the best way to do this), the CompactFlash card can be changed
quickly and safely.
Caution!
The power must be turned off before inserting or removing the CompactFlash card!
As a safety measure, a sticker is also attached to Power Panel devices stating this.
2.2 Stickers
The following sticker can be found in a suitable location on the Power Panel device:
General information
Each B&R device is given a unique serial number sticker with a barcode that allows the device
to be clearly identified.
Design / dimensions
60 mm
R2
5PP320.1505-39 Rev. R0
14 mm
91700168425
www.br-automation.com
MAC: 00-60-65-04-4C-09
5PP320.1505-39 Rev. R0
Information about each device can also be found on the B&R homepage. Enter the device's
serial number in the serial number search field on the start page www.br-automation.com. The
search also works if you enter the model number or the material number in the material number
search field.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Enter model number here
e.g. 5PP320.0571-29
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 5PP320.0571-29
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.0571-29
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color LCD
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 512 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 40:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 200 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.45 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 10 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.3.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 58
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.3.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196
3 46.5 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" QVGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.4.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 64
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.4.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196
3 46.5 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" QVGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 5PP320.0573-39
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.0573-39
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =80°
Vertical Direction U = 80°/ direction D = 70°
Background lighting
Brightness 350 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 75,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.54 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption 13 W typical
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.5.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 70
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.5.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196
3 46.5 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" VGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 5PP320.0573-3B
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 512 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.0573-3B
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =80°
Vertical Direction U = 80°/ direction D = 70°
Background lighting
Brightness 350 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 75,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.54 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption 13 W typical
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.6.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 76
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.6.3 Dimensions
2,9 9,4
8 196
3 46,5 6
Allgemeintoleranz nach
Nennmaßbereich DIN ISO 2768 mittel
bis 6 mm ± 0,1 mm
156
140
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" VGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
COM LEDs
Features 5PP320.1043-39
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.1043-39
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 3.7 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 2.7.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 82
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.7.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 300 3 54.5 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
260
240
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
100
10
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
260
251.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 303 mm ± 0.5 mm x 243 mm ± 0.5 mm
for
4PP320.1043-31
4PP420.1043-75
4PP420.1043-B5
4PP480.1043-75
5PP320.1043-39
8.5
0
323
0
313
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 10.4" VGA, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
COM LEDs
Features 5PP320.1214-39
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.1214-39
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 12.1 in (307 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution SVGA, 800 x 600 pixels
Contrast 300:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 50°/ direction D = 60°
Background lighting
Brightness 350 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 4.1 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +45°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.8.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 88
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.8.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
10 342 3 54.5 8
264
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
123.9
10
362 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
284
275.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 345 ±0.5 mm x 267 ±0.5 mm
for 5PP320.1214-39
8.5
0
362
8.5
353.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 12.1" SVGA, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
LEDs
COM
Features 5PP320.1505-39
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 256 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.1505-39
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 15 in (381 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.25 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 30 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 6.3 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.9.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 94
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.9.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 60.5 8
82
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 415 ±0.5 mm x 312 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.1505-31
4PP420.1505-75
4PP420.1505-B5
4PP480.1505-75
4PP480.1505-B5
5PP320.1505-39
5PP320.1505-3B
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 15" XGA, touch screen
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
LEDs
COM
Features 5PP320.1505-3B
Boot loader / Operating system BIOS
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 kB (64 kB I-Cache / 64 kB D-Cache)
L2 cache 128 kB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 512 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy at +25°C typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 4 years3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 Mbit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 5PP320.1505-3B
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 Mbit/s), full speed (12 Mbit/s), to high speed (480 Mbit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 15 in (381 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400, 1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L = 85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.25 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 30 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 6.3 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 2.9.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 94
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude7) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
2.10.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 60.5 8
82
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 415 ±0.5 mm x 312 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.1505-31
4PP420.1505-75
4PP420.1505-B5
4PP480.1505-75
4PP480.1505-B5
5PP320.1505-39
5PP320.1505-3B
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 15in XGA, touch screen
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
The following section provides a description of all interfaces and plugs possible with a
Power Panel 300 device with Automation Runtime.
The 3-pin socket required for the supply voltage connection is not included in delivery. This can
be ordered from B&R using the model number 0TB103.9 (screw clamps) or 0TB103.91 (cage
clamps).
The pin assignments can be found either in the following table or printed on the Power Panel
plate. The supply voltage is internally protected so that the device cannot be damaged if there is
an overload (fuse replacement necessary) or if the voltage supply is connected incorrectly
(reverse polarity protection - fuse replacement not necessary).
Supply voltage
Protected against reverse polarity
Pin Description
1 -
2 Functional ground
3 2 1
3 +
Accessories
0TB103.9 Plug 24 V 5.08 3p screw clamps
0TB103.91 Plug 24 V 5.08 3p cage clamps
Ground
Warning!
The pin's connection to the functional ground (pin 2, e.g. switching cabinet) should
be as short as possible. We recommend using the largest possible conductor cross
section on the supply plug.
Next to the supply voltage plug there is a functional grounding clip. The grounding clip (functional
ground) must be connected with a central grounding point on the switching cabinet using a 6.3
mm blade connector via the shortest distance and with as little resistance as possible (e.g.
copper strip, but must be at least 2.5 mm²).
Grounding clip
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 51: Functional grounding clip
The Power Panel is equipped with a PC-compatible serial interface with a 16-byte FIFO buffer.
This non-electrically isolated interface is primarily intended for programming Power Panel
devices using Automation Studio.
The RS232 can also be used as a general interface (e.g. third-party connections, barcode
reader, etc.).
4 DTR
5 GND
6 DSR
7 RTS
8 CTS
9 RI
The Power Panel 300/400 devices have a USB 2.0 (Universal Serial Bus) host controller with
multiple USB ports, two of which are on the outside for easy user access.
Technical data
cable length
Chapter 2
Table 36: USB port
1) The actual value depends on the operating system or diver being used.
2) For safety, every USB port is equipped with a maintenance free "USB current-limiting circuit breaker" (max. 500 mA)
Warning!
Peripheral USB devices can be connected to the USB interfaces. Due to the vast
number of USB devices available on the market, B&R cannot guarantee their
performance. B&R does ensure the performance of all USB devices that they
provide.
Warning!
Because of general PC specifications, this interface should be handled with extreme
care with regard to EMC, location of cables, etc.
Power Panel devices are equipped with 2 hex switches that serve as operating mode switches.
Switch positions 01 to FD are available for any purpose in an application and can be evaluated
by the application program.
Mode/Node switch
SW1 SW2
Switch position
SW1 (x16) SW2 (x1) Function Description
0 0 Boot Automation Runtime boot mode for operating system (firmware, BIOS) upgrade (default:
Automation Runtime).
In this position, a new or missing operating system can be downloaded.
Information:
For detailed information, see chapter 4 "Software" section3 "Upgrade
information" on page 456
0 ... F 0 ... D Node Automation Runtime run mode with node 01-FD (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or
terminal operation).
Freely available for use in an application, e.g. setting the INA2000 node number for the
Ethernet interface.
F E Dyn. mode Automation Runtime run mode with node 01-FD (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or
terminal operation).
Device addresses can be assigned through the software.
F F Diagnostics Automation Runtime diagnostics mode (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or terminal
operation).
Power Panel devices are equipped with a BIOS boot mode switch.
Technical data
Chapter 2
AR
-M
od
e
OS
-M
od
e
Table 39: BIOS boot mode switch positions (based on the image)
Warning!
Carefully use a pointed object to change switch position.
OS mode
• Standard Boot Screen (see section 1 "Power Panel 300 with BIOS" on page 397)
• BIOS Setup can be started by pressing the "DEL" key.
• When the switch is in the "00" position, the setup default values will be restored after
restarting three times.
AR mode
The device will be initialized for Automation Runtime when AR mode is enabled.
• Other boot screen (see section 2 "Power Panel 300/400 with Automation Runtime" on
page 452)
• USB Boot "Enabled" (only in switch position "00")
Power Panels are equipped with two status LEDs that are visible on the outside.
Status LEDs
LED Color Meaning
Green On Supply voltage OK 1x three-color, 1x one-color
The system is in standby mode
Power (S5: soft-off mode or S4:
Red On
hibernate mode - suspend-to-
Technical data
disk)
Chapter 2
Yellow On Can be used as the user wants
(for example, can be turned
User on/off directly using the ADI
Green Off library - only possible in S0
state)
Indicates access to
CF Yellow On CompactFlash drive (read or
write)
Ethernet connection
Controller Intel 82551ER RJ45 twisted pair (10BaseT/100BaseT), female
Cabling S/STP (category 5)
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s 1)
LED On Off
Green 100 MBit/s 10 MBit/s
Orange Link Activity (blinking)
(Ethernet network (Data transfer in
connection progress)
available)
Power button
Reset button
Warning!
A system reset can cause data to be lost!
Power Panel devices are equipped with a CompactFlash slot that is accessible from the side.
Type I CompactFlash cards are supported.
Ejection lever
Safety latch
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 53: CompactFlash slot
It is possible to secure the CompactFlash slot using the latch provided. By pressing the ejector
(using a pointed object is the best way to do this), the CompactFlash card can be changed
quickly and safely.
Caution!
The power must be turned off before inserting or removing the CompactFlash card!
As a safety measure, a sticker is also attached to Power Panel devices stating this.
3.2 Stickers
The following sticker can be found in a suitable location on the Power Panel device:
General information
Each B&R device is given a unique serial number sticker with a barcode that allows the device
to be clearly identified.
Design / dimensions
60 mm
R2
4PP420.1043-75 Rev. R0
14 mm
91490168421
www.br-automation.com
MAC: 00-60-65-00-C6-A7
4PP420.1043-75 Rev. R0
Information about each device can also be found on the B&R homepage. Enter the device's
serial number in the serial number search field on the start page www.br-automation.com. The
search also works if you enter the model number or the material number in the material number
search field.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Enter model number here
e.g. 4PP320.1043-01
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button SW2
(x1)
Reset button
SW1
Supply
(x16)
voltage
USB Status
LEDs
Ethernet
COM
Features 4PP320.0571-01
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP320.0571-01
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.03)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)3)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time4) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.45 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 10 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 3.3.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 118
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.3.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196
3 46.5 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" QVGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button SW2
(x1)
Reset button
SW1
Supply
(x16)
voltage
USB Status
LEDs
Ethernet
COM
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 1.4 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 3.4.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 124
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.4.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196
3 46.5 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 143 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.0571-01
4PP320.0571-35
4PP420.0571-45
4PP420.0571-65
4PP420.0571-75
4PP420.0571-85
4PP420.0571-A5
4PP420.0571-B5
4PP420.0573-75
5PP320.0571-29
5PP320.0571-39
5PP320.0573-39
5PP320.0573-3B
6.5
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 5.7" QVGA, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
Grounding
clip
CompactFlash slot
Power button (with latch)
Reset button
SW2
Supply
(x1)
voltage
SW1
USB (x16)
Ethernet Status
COM LEDs
Features 4PP320.1043-31
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP320.1043-31
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.03)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)3)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 3)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time4) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 3.7 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 3.5.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 130
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.5.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 300 3 54.5 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
260
240
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
100
10
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
260
251.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 303 mm ± 0.5 mm x 243 mm ± 0.5 mm
for
4PP320.1043-31
4PP420.1043-75
4PP420.1043-B5
4PP480.1043-75
5PP320.1043-39
8.5
0
323
0
313
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 10.4" VGA, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button SW2
(x1)
Reset button
SW1
Supply
(x16)
voltage
USB Status
LEDs
Ethernet
COM
Features 4PP320.1505-31
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP320.1505-31
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.03)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)3)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 15 in (381 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors3)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time4) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.25 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 30 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Technical data
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Chapter 2
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 6.3 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 3.6.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 136
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.6.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 60.5 8
82
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 415 ±0.5 mm x 312 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP320.1505-31
4PP420.1505-75
4PP420.1505-B5
4PP480.1505-75
4PP480.1505-B5
5PP320.1505-39
5PP320.1505-3B
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP320 BIOS 15" XGA, touch screen
8 Retaining clips included
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Features 4PP351.0571-01
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP351.0571-01
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.03)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)3)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time4) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED
Function keys 16 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 6 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.45 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 10 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Technical data
Membrane Polyester
Chapter 2
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 3.7.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 142
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.7.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
8 196 3 46.5 6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Technical data
Cutout
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 226.8 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP351.0571-01
4PP351.0571-35
4PP451.0571-45
4PP451.0571-65
4PP451.0571-75
4PP451.0571-85
4PP451.0571-B5
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP351 BIOS 5.7" QVGA
4 Retaining clips included
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.45 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 10 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Technical data
Membrane Polyester
Chapter 2
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 3.8.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 148
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.8.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
8 196 3 46.5 6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Technical data
Cutout
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 226.8 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP351.0571-01
4PP351.0571-35
4PP451.0571-45
4PP451.0571-65
4PP451.0571-75
4PP451.0571-85
4PP451.0571-B5
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP351 BIOS 5.7" QVGA
4 Retaining clips included
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB
Ethernet
COM
Status SW2
LEDs SW1
(x1)
(x16)
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Technical data
Width 302 mm
Chapter 2
Height 187 mm
Depth 55.5 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized5)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.2 kg
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 3.9.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 154
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude6) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.9.3 Dimensions
2.9 11.9
8 286
3 46.5 6
302
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
187
180.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 289 ±0.5 mm x 174 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP352.0571-35
4PP452.0571-45
4PP452.0571-65
4PP452.0571-75
4PP452.0571-B5
6.5
0
302
6.5
295.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP352 5.7in QVGA
4 Retaining clips included
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding clip
Power button
SW2
Reset button (x1)
Supply SW1
voltage USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP381.1043-31
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM -
Quantity
Battery-buffered
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time -
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered -
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery -
Type
Removable
Lifespan
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP381.1043-31
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.03)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)3)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots -
Holding torque for aPCI module
Features 4PP381.1043-31
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Technical data
Half-brightness time4) 55,000 hours
Chapter 2
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED
Function keys 28 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.45 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 10 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 323 mm
Height 358 mm
Depth 65.5 mm
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
3.10.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 54.5 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
358
193
15
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
358
349.5
Cutout
13.5
0
0
10
313
323
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP381 BIOS 10.4" QVGA, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
The following section provides a description of all interfaces and plugs possible with a
Power Panel 400 device with Automation Runtime.
Technical data
Input voltage: 18 - 30 VDC
Chapter 2
The 3-pin socket required for the supply voltage connection is not included in delivery. This can
be ordered from B&R using the model number 0TB103.9 (screw clamps) or 0TB103.91 (cage
clamps).
The pin assignments can be found either in the following table or printed on the Power Panel
plate. The supply voltage is internally protected so that the device cannot be damaged if there is
an overload (fuse replacement necessary) or if the voltage supply is connected incorrectly
(reverse polarity protection - fuse replacement not necessary).
Supply voltage
Protected against reverse polarity
Pin Description
1 -
2 Functional ground
3 2 1
3 +
Accessories
0TB103.9 Plug 24 V 5.08 3p screw clamps
0TB103.91 Plug 24 V 5.08 3p cage clamps
Ground
Warning!
The pin's connection to the functional ground (pin 2, e.g. switching cabinet) should
be as short as possible. We recommend using the largest possible conductor cross
section on the supply plug.
Next to the supply voltage plug there is a functional grounding clip. The grounding clip (functional
ground) must be connected with a central grounding point on the switching cabinet using a 6.3
mm blade connector via the shortest distance and with as little resistance as possible (e.g.
copper strip, but must be at least 2.5 mm²).
Grounding clip
The Power Panel is equipped with a PC-compatible serial interface with a 16-byte FIFO buffer.
This non-electrically isolated interface is primarily intended for programming Power Panel
devices using Automation Studio.
The RS232 can also be used as a general interface (e.g. third-party connections, barcode
reader, etc.).
Technical data
Type RS232, modem-capable, not
Chapter 2
electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte
FIFO
Transfer rate Up to 115 kBaud 9-pin DSUB plug
Pin Assignment
1 DCD
1 5
2 RxD
3 TxD 6 9
4 DTR
5 GND
6 DSR
7 RTS
8 CTS
9 RI
The Power Panel 300/400 devices have a USB 2.0 (Universal Serial Bus) host controller with
multiple USB ports, two of which are on the outside for easy user access.
1) The actual value depends on the operating system or diver being used.
2) For safety, every USB port is equipped with a maintenance free "USB current-limiting circuit breaker" (max. 500 mA)
Warning!
Peripheral USB devices can be connected to the USB interfaces. Due to the vast
number of USB devices available on the market, B&R cannot guarantee their
performance. B&R does ensure the performance of all USB devices that they
provide.
Warning!
Because of general PC specifications, this interface should be handled with extreme
care with regard to EMC, location of cables, etc.
Power Panel devices are equipped with 2 hex switches that serve as operating mode switches.
Switch positions 01 to FD are available for any purpose in an application and can be evaluated
by the application program.
Mode/Node switch
Technical data
Chapter 2
SW1 SW2
Switch position
SW1 (x16) SW2 (x1) Function Description
0 0 Boot Automation Runtime boot mode for operating system (firmware, BIOS) upgrade (default:
Automation Runtime).
In this position, a new or missing operating system can be downloaded.
Information:
For detailed information, see chapter 4 "Software" section3 "Upgrade
information" on page 456.
0 ... F 0 ... D Node Automation Runtime run mode with node 01-FD (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or
terminal operation).
Freely available for CompactFlash users, e.g. setting the INA2000 node number for the
Ethernet interface.
F E Dyn. mode Automation Runtime run mode with node 01-FD (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or
terminal operation).
Device addresses can be assigned through the software.
F F Diagnostics Automation Runtime diagnostics mode (CompactFlash Automation Runtime or terminal
operation).
Power Panel devices are equipped with a BIOS boot mode switch.
AR
-M
od
e
OS
-M
od
e
Table 64: BIOS boot mode switch positions (based on the image)
Warning!
Carefully use a pointed object to change switch position.
OS mode
• Standard Boot Screen (see section 1 "Power Panel 300 with BIOS" on page 397)
• BIOS Setup can be started by pressing the "DEL" key.
• When the switch is in the "00" position, the setup default values will be restored after
restarting three times.
AR mode
Technical data
The device will be initialized for Automation Runtime when AR mode is enabled.
Chapter 2
• Other boot screen (see section 2 "Power Panel 300/400 with Automation Runtime" on
page 452)
• USB Boot "Enabled" (only in switch position "00")
Power Panels are equipped with two status LEDs that are visible on the outside.
Status LEDs
LED Color Meaning
Green On Supply voltage OK 1x three-color, 1x one-color
The system is in standby mode
Power (S5: soft-off mode or S4:
Red On
hibernate mode - suspend-to-
disk)
Yellow On Can be used as the user wants
(for example, can be turned
User on/off directly using the ADI
Green Off library - only possible in S0
state)
Indicates access to
CF Yellow On CompactFlash drive (read or
write)
Ethernet connection
Controller Intel 82551ER RJ45 twisted pair (10BaseT/100BaseT), female
Cabling S/STP (category 5)
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s 1)
LED On Off
Green 100 MBit/s 10 MBit/s
Orange Link Activity (blinking)
(Ethernet network (Data transfer in
connection progress)
available)
Power button
Technical data
Chapter 2
Table 67: Power button
Reset button
Warning!
A system reset can cause data to be lost!
Power Panel devices are equipped with a CompactFlash slot that is accessible from the side.
Type I CompactFlash cards are supported.
Ejection lever
Safety latch
It is possible to secure the CompactFlash slot using the latch provided. By pressing the ejector
(using a pointed object is the best way to do this), the CompactFlash card can be changed
quickly and safely.
Caution!
The power must be turned off before inserting or removing the CompactFlash card!
As a safety measure, a sticker is also attached to Power Panel devices stating this.
Either 1 or 2 aPCI slots are available depending on the Power Panel variant. B&R System 2005
aPCI interface modules can be inserted (available aPCI interface modules - see B&R homepage
- Products - Control systems - System 2005 - Communication modules).
aPCI
Slot
2
aPC
I Slo
t1
4.2 Stickers
The following sticker can be found in a suitable location on the Power Panel device:
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 102: Device label
General information
Each B&R device is given a unique serial number sticker with a barcode that allows the device
to be clearly identified.
Design / dimensions
60 mm
R2
4PP420.1043-75 Rev. R0
14 mm
91490168421
www.br-automation.com
MAC: 00-60-65-00-C6-A7
4PP420.1043-75 Rev. R0
Information about each device can also be found on the B&R homepage. Enter the device's
serial number in the serial number search field on the start page www.br-automation.com. The
search also works if you enter the model number or the material number in the material number
search field.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 105: Front view - 4PP420.0571-45
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 4PP420.0571-45
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.0571-45
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.3.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 67 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 110: Front view - 4PP420.0571-65
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 4PP420.0571-65
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.0571-65
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color LCD
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 512 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 40:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 200 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.4.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 67 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420, 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 115: Front view - 4PP420.0571-75
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4) 262,144 colors 3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 400:1 350:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =60° Direction R / direction L =65°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50° Direction U = 65°/ direction D = 40°
Background lighting
Brightness 500 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.5.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 67 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420, 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 120: Front view - 4PP420.0571-85
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 4PP420.0571-A5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.0571-A5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.6.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 89 6
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
212
8
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420, 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 125: Front view - 4PP420.0571-A5
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 4PP420.0571-A5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.0571-A5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color LCD
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 512 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 40:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 200 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.7.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 89 6
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
212
8
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420, 5.7" QVGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 130: Front view - 4PP420.0571-B5
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4) 262,144 colors 3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 400:1 350:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =60° Direction R / direction L =65°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50° Direction U = 65°/ direction D = 40°
Background lighting
Brightness 500 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.8.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 89 6
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
212
8
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420, 5.7" QVGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 135: Front view - 4PP420.0573-75
Battery compartment
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Power button
Reset button
Supply
voltage USB CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs SW1 SW2
(x16) (x1)
Features 4PP420.0573-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.0573-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =80°
Vertical Direction U = 80°/ direction D = 70°
Background lighting
Brightness 350 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 75,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.9.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.4
8 196 3 67 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
8
212
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
156
149.5
Cutout
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 5.7" VGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
4 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 140: Front view - 4PP420.1043-75
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
LEDs
COM
Features 4PP420.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. D0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.71 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 17 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.10.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 300 3 75 8
240
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
100
10
323 27 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
260
251.5
Cutout
8.5
0
323
0
313
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 145: Front view - 4PP420.1043-B5
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1 Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
LEDs
COM
Features 4PP420.1043-B5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. D0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.1043-B5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.71 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 17 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.11.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 97 8
240
up to 6 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
100
10
323 27 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
260
251.5
Cutout
8.5
0
323
0
313
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 10.4" VGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 150: Front view - 4PP420.1505-75
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP420.1505-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.1505-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 15 in (381 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.25 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 30 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.12.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 76 8
81.5
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 27 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 15" XGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Figure 155: Front view - 4PP420.1505-B5
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP420.1505-B5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP420.1505-B5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 15 in (381 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.25 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 30 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.13.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 98 8
81.5
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 27 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP420 15" XGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Battery
compartment
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Features 4PP451.0571-45
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP451.0571-45
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 16 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 6 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.14.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
8 196 3 67 6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Cutout
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Battery
compartment
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Features 4PP451.0571-65
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP451.0571-65
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color LCD
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 512 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 40:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 200 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 16 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 6 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.15.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
8 196 3 67 6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Cutout
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Battery
compartment
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4) 262,144 colors 3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 400:1 350:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =60° Direction R / direction L =65°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50° Direction U = 65°/ direction D = 40°
Background lighting
Brightness 500 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 16 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 6 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
5) At +25°C ambient temperature. Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-brightness
time.
6) The functions of the keys and the LEDs can be configured using B&R Automation Studio - Visual Components.
7) Depending on the process or batch, there may be visible deviations in the color and surface structure.
8) Derating the maximum ambient temperature - typically 1°C per 1000 meters (from 500 meters above sea level).
100
Technical data
95
Chapter 2
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.16.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
8 196 3 67 6
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Technical data
Cutout
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 226.8 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP351.0571-01
4PP351.0571-35
4PP451.0571-45
4PP451.0571-65
4PP451.0571-75
4PP451.0571-85
4PP451.0571-B5
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Battery
compartment
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Features 4PP451.0571-85
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP451.0571-85
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 16 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 6 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Technical data
Membrane Polyester
Chapter 2
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.7 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 4.17.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 264
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card, inserted aPCI module
or with an optional aPCI cover)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude8) Max. 3000 m
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.17.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
8 196 3 89 6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Technical data
Cutout
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 199 ±0.5 mm x 226.8 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP351.0571-01
4PP351.0571-35
4PP451.0571-45
4PP451.0571-65
4PP451.0571-75
4PP451.0571-85
4PP451.0571-B5
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Grounding clip
Battery
compartment
Power button
Reset button CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet SW2
COM (x1)
SW1
Status (x16)
LEDs
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Technical data
Width 212 mm
Chapter 2
Height 245 mm
Depth 98 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.7 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 4.18.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 270
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card, inserted aPCI module
or with an optional aPCI cover)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude8) Max. 3000 m
5) At +25°C ambient temperature. Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-brightness
time.
6) The functions of the keys and the LEDs can be configured using B&R Automation Studio - Visual Components.
7) Depending on the process or batch, there may be visible deviations in the color and surface structure.
8) Derating the maximum ambient temperature - typically 1°C per 1000 meters (from 500 meters above sea level).
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.18.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
8 196 3 89 6
Technical data
Chapter 2
Nominal measurement General tolerance from
range DIN ISO 2768 medium
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
140
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
82
245
97
13.2
212 28
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
245
238.5
Cutout
11.7
0
212
6.5
205.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
Battery
compartment
aPCI Slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding clip
Power button
SW2
Reset button (x1)
Supply SW1
voltage USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP451.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP451.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 28 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.19.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 75 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
333
358
193
15
323 27,5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
358
349.5
Cutout
13.5
0
0
10
313
323
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
Battery
compartment
aPCI slot 2
aPCI slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB
(x16)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs
Features 4PP451.1043-B5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP451.1043-B5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 in (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 28 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.20.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 75 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
333
358
193
15
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
358
349.5
Cutout
13.5
0
0
10
313
323
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP451 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be labeled using legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
Grounding
clip Power button
CompactFlash slot
Reset button (with latch)
Supply
voltage USB
Ethernet
COM
Status SW2
LEDs SW1
(x1)
(x16)
Features 4PP452.0571-45
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP452.0571-45
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys -
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan 6
> 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.21.3 Dimensions
2.9 196
11.9
8 286 3 67 6
171
302 47
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
187
180.5
Cutout
6.5
0
302
6.5
295.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
10 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be labeled using legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
Grounding
clip Power button
CompactFlash slot
Reset button (with latch)
Supply
voltage USB
Ethernet
COM
Status SW2
LEDs SW1
(x1)
(x16)
Features 4PP452.0571-65
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP452.0571-65
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color LCD
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 512 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 40:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 200 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys -
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan 6
> 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.22.3 Dimensions
2.9 196
11.9
8 286 3 67 6
171
302 47
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
187
180.5
Cutout
6.5
0
302
6.5
295.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
10 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be labeled using legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
Grounding
clip Power button
CompactFlash slot
Reset button (with latch)
Supply
voltage USB
Ethernet
COM
Status SW2
LEDs SW1
(x1)
(x16)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4) 262,144 colors 3)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 400:1 350:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =60° Direction R / direction L =65°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D = 50° Direction U = 65°/ direction D = 40°
Background lighting
Brightness 500 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass
Degree of transmission 95%
Coating On both sides
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys -
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
6
Key lifespan > 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
5) At +25°C ambient temperature. Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-brightness
time.
6) The functions of the keys and the LEDs can be configured using B&R Automation Studio - Visual Components.
7) Depending on the process or batch, there may be visible deviations in the color and surface structure.
8) Derating the maximum ambient temperature - typically 1°C per 1000 meters (from 500 meters above sea level).
100
Technical data
95
Chapter 2
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.23.3 Dimensions
2.9 196
11.9
8 286 3 67 6
171
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
82
31
8
302 47
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
187
180.5
Cutout
Technical data
Chapter 2
Cutout dimensions 289 ±0.5 mm x 174 ±0.5 mm
for
4PP352.0571-35
4PP452.0571-45
4PP452.0571-65
4PP452.0571-75
4PP452.0571-B5
6.5
0
302
6.5
295.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
10 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Battery
compartment
aPCI slot 2
aPCI slot 1
Grounding
clip Power button
CompactFlash slot
Reset button (with latch)
Supply
voltage USB
Ethernet
COM
Status SW2
LEDs SW1
(x1)
(x16)
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Technical data
Width 302 mm
Chapter 2
Height 187 mm
Depth 98 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.9 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 4.24.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 308
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
Protection type IP20 back side (only with installed CompactFlash card, inserted aPCI module
or with an optional aPCI cover)
IP65 / NEMA 250 type 4X, dust and sprayed water protection (front side)
Altitude8) Max. 3000 m
5) At +25°C ambient temperature. Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-brightness
time.
6) The functions of the keys and the LEDs can be configured using B&R Automation Studio - Visual Components.
7) Depending on the process or batch, there may be visible deviations in the color and surface structure.
8) Derating the maximum ambient temperature - typically 1°C per 1000 meters (from 500 meters above sea level).
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.24.3 Dimensions
Technical data
8 286
Chapter 2
3 89 6
Nominal
measurement General tolerance from
range DIN ISO 2768 medium
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
171
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
187
82
31
8
302 47
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
187
180.5
Cutout
6.5
0
302
6.5
295.5
0
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP452 5.7" QVGA, 1 aPCI, keys
10 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be labeled using legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button SW2
(x1)
Reset button SW1
Supply (x16)
voltage
USB Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP452.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP452.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 inch (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen -
Touch screen type
Technology
Controller
Degree of transmission
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 44 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys -
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 1,000,000 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.38 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 23 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.25.3 Dimensions
Nominal
measurement General tolerance
81.5
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
288
14.5
423 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
288
279.5
Cutout
13
0
412
0
10
423
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP482 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, keys
12 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Grounding clip
Supply SW2
voltage (x1)
USB SW1
(x16)
Ethernet Status
LEDs
COM
Features 4PP480.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP480.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 inch (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 12 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys -
Number block -
Other keys -
Key lifespan 6
> 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.84 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 20 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.26.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 300 3 75 8
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
260
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
100
10
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
260
251.5
Cutout
8.5
0
323
0
313
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP480 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
6 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP480.1505-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP480.1505-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 38.10 cm (380 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 12 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys -
Number block -
Other keys -
Key lifespan 6
> 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.84 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 20 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.27.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 76 8
81.6
309
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 mm ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 mm ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP480 15" XGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
aPCI Slot 2
aPCI Slot 1
Battery compartment
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP480.1505-B5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP480.1505-B5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 38.10 cm (380 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 12 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys -
Number block -
Other keys -
Key lifespan 6
> 10 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.84 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 20 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.28.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 412 3 98 8
Nominal
81.6
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
over 30 to 120 mm ± 0.3 mm
over 120 to 400 ± 0.5 mm
over 400 to 1000 ± 0.8 mm
169
10.5
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
330
321
Cutout
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP480 15" XGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
8 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
Battery
compartment
aPCI Slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding clip
Power button
SW2
Reset button (x1)
Supply SW1
voltage USB (x16)
Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP481.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP481.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 inch (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 28 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.84 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 20 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.29.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 75 8
193
15
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
358
349.5
Cutout
13.5
0
0
10
313
323
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP481 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
12 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
Battery
compartment
aPCI slot 2
aPCI slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button
Reset button
SW2
Supply (x1)
voltage SW1
USB
(x16)
Ethernet
COM
Status
LEDs
Features 4PP481.1043-B5
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP481.1043-B5
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 2 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 inch (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 28 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 10 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.84 A
Starting current Max. 2.8 A
Power consumption Typically 20 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.30.3 Dimensions
9.9
2.9
11.5 300 3 97 8
15
323 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
358
349.5
Cutout
13.5
0
0
10
313
323
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP481 10.4" VGA, 2 aPCI, touch screen, keys
12 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be Keys can be
labeled using labeled using
legend strips legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
SW2
(x1)
Grounding
SW1
clip
(x16)
Power button
Status
Reset button LEDs
Supply
voltage
USB
Ethernet
COM
Features 4PP481.1505-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB Rev. < C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP481.1505-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 38.10 cm (380 mm)
Colors 16.7 million colors4)
Resolution XGA, 1024 x 768 pixels
Contrast 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =85°
Vertical Direction U / direction D = 85°
Background lighting
Brightness 250 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 20 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys 12 with LED (yellow)
Cursor keys 4 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys 73 without LED
Key lifespan > 106 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.38 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 23 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.31.3 Dimensions
2.9 9.9
11.5 412 3 76 8
81.6
409.5
10
435 28.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
430
421
Cutout
9
0
425
435
0
10
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP481 15" XGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
12 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Technical data
Chapter 2
Keys can be labeled using legend strips
Battery compartment
aPCI slot 1
CompactFlash slot
(with latch)
Grounding
clip
Power button SW2
(x1)
Reset button SW1
Supply (x16)
voltage
USB Status
Ethernet LEDs
COM
Features 4PP482.1043-75
Boot loader / Operating system Automation Runtime
Processor
Type Geode LX800 500 MHz, 32-bit x86
Expanded command set MMX technology, 3D Now
L1 cache 128 KB (64 KB L cache / 64 KB D cache)
L2 cache 128 KB
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB (64 MB < Rev. C0)
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Serial interface
Type RS232, modem-capable, not electrically isolated
UART 16C550 compatible, 16-byte FIFO
Transfer rate Max. 115 kBaud
Connection 9-pin DSUB
Features 4PP482.1043-75
USB interface
Type USB 1.1, USB 2.04)
Amount 2
Transfer rate Low speed (1.5 MBit/s), full speed (12 MBit/s) to high speed (480 MBit/s)4)
Connection Type A
Current load Max. 500 mA per connection
Reset button Yes, accessible from the outside
Power button Yes, accessible from the outside
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Technical data
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Chapter 2
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 (see B&R System 2005 manual for available aPCI interface modules)
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type Color TFT
Diagonal 10.4 inch (264 mm)
Colors 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution VGA, 640 x 480 pixels
Contrast 600:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =70°
Vertical Direction U = 45°/ direction D = 35°
Background lighting
Brightness 450 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 55,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 "Commissioning", section "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Elo Accu Touch
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED6)
Function keys 44 with LED (yellow)
Soft keys -
Cursor keys 5 without LED
Number block 15 without LED
Other keys -
Key lifespan > 1,000,000 actuations with 1 ±0.3 to 3 ±0.3 N operating force
LED brightness Typ. 12 mcd (yellow) and 20 mcd (green)
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys,
and may trigger unintended actions.
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 1.38 A
Starting current Max. 2 A
Power consumption Typically 23 W
Electrical isolation Yes
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Technical data
Transport
50
Storage
Chapter 2
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
4.32.3 Dimensions
up to 6 mm ± 0.1 mm
263.5
over 6 to 30 mm ± 0.2 mm
288
14.5
423 27.5
The cutout hole is to be made according to the following dimensions for cutout installation. The
device must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
288
279.5
Cutout
13
0
412
0
10
423
The following components are included in the delivery of the Power Panel device:
Amount Component
1 Power Panel PP482 10.4" VGA, 1 aPCI, touch screen, keys
12 Retaining clips included
1 Lithium battery 3 V / 950 mAh included
Power Panel 400 light / compact series devices have QVGA operator panels with an integrated
controller.
Power Panel 400 light devices are primarily intended for applications which rely on CAN bus or
X2X interfaces for connecting peripherals without requiring Ethernet.
Devices from the compact series are also equipped with a 10/100 Ethernet interface, making
them the ideal choice anywhere a network connection to a higher-level computer is required.
Technical data
Power Panel devices are delivered as B&R sets, i.e. already with an inserted aPCI module. The
Chapter 2
following QVGA Power Panel light / compact versions are available:
Technical data
Background lighting
Chapter 2
Brightness 220 cd/m² 200 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 Yes, see chapter 3 Yes, see chapter 3
"Commissioning", section "Commissioning", section "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.5 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 12 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 212 mm
Height 156 mm
Depth 76 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized6)
Design Gray6)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV6)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV6)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
The following diagram is valid for the devices 4PP420:0571-L05 and 4PP420:0571-L45.
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
Technical data
65
60
Chapter 2
55
50 Transport
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
5.1.3 Temperature humidity diagram - PP420 light LCD color and TFT color
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
Figure 256: Temperature humidity diagram - PP420 light LCD color and TFT color
Technical data
LEDs 1x CF (yellow)
Chapter 2
1x combined power (red/green) and user (yellow)
Mode/Node switch 2, 16 digits each
aPCI slots 1 pcs. 1 pcs. 1 pcs. 1 pcs. 1 pcs. 1 pcs.
CAN aPCI X2X aPCI CAN aPCI X2X aPCI CAN aPCI X2X aPCI
module module module module module module
(3IF771.9) (3IF791.9) (3IF771.9) (3IF791.9) (3IF771.9) (3IF791.9)
inserted inserted inserted inserted inserted inserted
Holding torque for aPCI module Max. 0.7 Nm
Display
Type LCD monochrome Color LCD Color TFT
Diagonal 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm) 5.7 in (144 mm)
Colors 8 shades of gray4) 512 colors 4) 262,144 colors 4)
Resolution QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels QVGA, 320 x 240 pixels
Contrast 25:1 40:1 400:1
Viewing angle (see page 536)
Horizontal Direction R / direction L =40° Direction R / direction L =40° Direction R / direction L =60°
Vertical Direction U = 40°/ direction D Direction U = 40°/ direction D Direction U = 40°/ direction D
= 50° = 50° = 50°
Background lighting
Brightness 220 cd/m² 200 cd/m² 500 cd/m²
Half-brightness time5) 50,000 hours 50,000 hours 50,000 hours
Screen rotation Yes, see chapter 3 Yes, see chapter 3 Yes, see chapter 3
"Commissioning", section "Commissioning", section "Commissioning", section
"Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394 "Screen rotation" on page 394
Touch screen
Touch screen type Gunze
Technology Analog, resistive
Controller Elo, serial, 12- bit
Degree of transmission Up to 80% ±5%
Filter glass -
Degree of transmission
Coating
Keys/LED -
Function keys
Soft keys
Cursor keys
Number block
Other keys
Key lifespan
LED brightness
4) The actual value depends on the operating system or diver being used.
5) At +25°C ambient temperature. Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-brightness
time.
6) Depending on the process or batch, there may be visible deviations in the color and surface structure.
7) Derating the maximum ambient temperature - typically 1°C per 1000 meters (from 500 meters above sea level).
The following diagram is valid for the devices 4PP420:0571-C05 and 4PP420:0571-C45.
Technical data
Chapter 2
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
5.1.6 Temperature humidity diagram - PP420 compact LCD color and TFT color
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
Figure 258: Temperature humidity diagram - PP420 compact LCD color and TFT color
Technical data
L2 cache 128 KB
Chapter 2
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet -
Controller
Transfer rate
Connection
Cables
NE2000-compatible
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys, and may trigger
unintended actions.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 212 mm
Height 245 mm
Depth 76 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.4 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 5.2.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 372
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys, and may trigger
unintended actions.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 212 mm
Height 245 mm
Depth 76 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 2.4 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 5.2.4 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 376
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
Technical data
L2 cache 128 KB
Chapter 2
Floating point unit (FPU) Yes
Cooling
Method Passive (heat sink)
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM DDR SDRAM DDR SDRAM DDR SDRAM
Quantity 64 MB 128 MB 64 MB 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 256 KB 512 KB 256 KB 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes Yes Yes Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet -
Controller
Transfer rate
Connection
Cables
NE2000-compatible
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys, and may trigger
unintended actions.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Electrical characteristics
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 323 mm
Height 358 mm
Depth 108 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 5.3 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 5.3.2 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 380
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
Technical data
Method Passive (heat sink)
Chapter 2
Flash 2 MB (for firmware)
Memory
Type DDR SDRAM
Quantity 128 MB
Graphics
Controller Geode LX800
Memory 8 MB shared memory (reserved by main memory)
SRAM
Quantity 512 KB
Battery-buffered Yes
Watchdog
Controller MTCX1)
Power failure logic
Controller MTCX1)
Buffer time 10 ms
Real-time clock (RTC)
Battery-buffered Yes
Accuracy At +25°C: typically 30 ppm (2.5 seconds) 2) per day
Battery
Type Renata 950 mAh
Removable Yes, accessible from the outside
Lifespan 3 years 3)
Backup capacitor (for changing battery)
Buffer time 10 minutes
Ethernet
Controller Intel 82551ER
Transfer rate 10/100 MBit/s
Connection RJ45 twisted pair (10 Base T / 100 Base T)
Cables S/STP (category 5)
NE2000-compatible -
CompactFlash
Type Type I
Amount 1 slot
Connection Primary IDE device
Pressing more than one key at a time may result in so-called phantom keys, and may trigger
unintended actions.
Technical data
Chapter 2
Power supply
Rated voltage 18 - 30 VDC
Rated current 0.63 A
Starting current Max. 1.2 A
Power consumption Typically 15 W
Electrical isolation Yes
Bleeder resistance 0Ω
Mechanical characteristics
Outer dimensions
Width 323 mm
Height 358 mm
Depth 108 mm
Front
Frame Aluminum, naturally anodized7)
Design Gray7)
Membrane Polyester
Dark gray border around display Similar to Pantone 432CV7)
Light background Similar to Pantone 427CV7)
Orange keys Similar to Pantone 151CV7)
Dark gray keys Similar to Pantone 431CV7)
Legend strips (gray) Similar to Pantone 429CV7)
Gasket Flat gasket around display front
Housing Metal
Weight Approx. 5.3 kg (without aPCI interface modules)
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Storage -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity See 5.3.4 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 384
Vibration
Operation (continuous) 2 - 9 Hz: 1.75 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 0.5 g
Operation (occasional) 2 - 9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude / 9 - 200 Hz: 1 g
Storage 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Transport 2 - 8 Hz: 7.5 mm amplitude / 8 - 200 Hz: 2 g / 200 - 500 Hz: 4 g
Shock
Operation 15 g, 11 ms
Storage 30 g, 15 ms
Transport 30 g, 15 ms
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
50
Storage
45 Operation
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
6. Block diagram
The following block diagrams show the simplified system unit structure with a CPU board.
Technical data
Chapter 2
5V 5V Line
driver Elo Touch
CMOS contrl.
DC/DC DC/DC DC/DC <>
switching switching isolated > 2.7V Rs232
> 11V
DCD, RI
93C46
Vbat 6-pin
5V
RXD, TXD,
RTS, CTS
5V 3V3 15.6V
LED
green / red
Clock
generator
LCD B/W LCD bias
MK1491-09
Temp.
diode
processor BGA196
Geode
TFT dig. ALXC800
FFC 30-pin
JTAG
BGA481 25 MHz
TFT dig.
FFC 33-pin
input port
controller
memory
Geode
Video
DDR SDRAM
Interface
SMB
Echtzeituhr
RTC USB1
Times
GPIO
USB USB4
BIOS AMD OHCI / EHCI OTG
Flash LPC
2 MB
CS5536
Companion Device IDE Compact
UART2 BGA208 controller Flash
LED
Speaker
yellow
RxD, TxD
AC97
JTAG
UART1
Internal connections
5V 5V Line
driver Elo Touch
CMOS contrl.
DC/DC DC/DC DC/DC <>
switching switching isolated > 2.7V Rs232
> 11V
DCD, RI
93C46
Vbat 6-pin
5V
RXD, TXD,
RTS, CTS
5V 3V3 15,6V
LED
green / red
Clock aPCI
generator Backplane
LCD B/W LCD bias
MK1491-09
Temp.
Diode
pricessor BGA196
Geode
TFT dig. ALXC800
FFC 30-pin
JTAG
BGA481 25MHz
TFT dig.
FFC 33-pin
Controller
input port
Memory
Geode
Video
DDR SDRAM
interface
SMB
Real-time
clock RTC USB1
Times
GPIO
USB USB4
BIOS AMD OHCI / EHCI OTG
Flash LPC
2 MB
CS5536
Companion device IDE Compact
UART2 BGA208 controller Flash
LED
Speaker
yellow
RxD, TxD
AC97
JTAG
UART1
Internal connections
Figure 264: Block diagram - Power Panel 400 with 1 aPCI slot
5V 5V Line
driver Elo touch
CMOS contrl.
DC/DC DC/DC DC/DC <>
switching switching isolated > 2.7 V Rs232
> 11 V
DCD, RI
93C46
Vbat 6-pin
Technical data
5V
Chapter 2
RXD, TXD,
RTS, CTS
5V 3V3 15.6 V
LED
green / red
Clock 2 aPCI
generator backplanes
LCD B/W LCD bias
MK1491-09
Temp.
diode
processor BGA196
Geode
TFT dig. ALXC800
FFC 30-pin
JTAG
BGA481 25 MHz
TFT dig.
FFC 33-pin
input port
controller
memory
Geode
Video
DDR SDRAM
Interface
SMB
Real-time
clock RTC USB1
Times
GPIO
USB USB4
BIOS AMD OHCI / EHCI OTG
Flash LPC
2 MB
CS5536
Companion Device IDE Compact
UART2 BGA208 controller Flash
LED
Speaker
yellow
RxD, TxD
AC97
JTAG
UART1
interne Anschlüsse
Figure 265: Block diagram - Power Panel 400 with 2 aPCI slots
Chapter 3 • Commissioning
1. Mounting instructions
• The Power Panel must be mounted using the retaining clips included in delivery.
Depending on the Power Panel version a corresponding number of retaining clips are
included.
Commissioning
Chapter 3
Figure 266: Retaining clip
• In order to guarantee proper air circulation, allow a sufficient amount of space above,
below, to the side and behind the Power Panel device. The minimum specified free space
can be found in the diagram below. Free space specifications apply to all Power Panel
versions (with/without aPCI slots and keys).
Side view
At least 80 mm
Air flow
At least 80 mm
At least 80 mm
Air flow
Rear view
At least 40 mm At least 40 mm
2. Mounting orientation
The following diagram displays the specified mounting orientation for the Power Panel device.
The mounting orientation applies to all Power Panel versions (with/without aPCI slots and keys).
Mounting orientation 0°
0°
Commissioning
Chapter 3
Table 136: Mounting orientation 0°
0° 0°
° +45
-45 °
Caution!
The maximum permitted ambient temperature can be found in the technical data for
the respective Power Panel device.
B&R touch screen devices are equipped with a touch controller, which supports hardware
calibration. This means that the devices are pre-calibrated from stock (pre-calibration). This
feature proves advantageous in the case of a replacement part because a new calibration is no
longer required when exchanging devices (identical model / type). Nevertheless, we recommend
calibrating the device in order to achieve the best results and to better readjust the touch screen
to the user's preferences.
Regardless of this, the touch screen driver requires calibration following installation.
3.1 Windows CE
Windows CE starts the touch screen calibration sequence during its first boot in the default
configuration / delivered state.
Commissioning
Chapter 3
After first starting Windows XP embedded (First Boot Agent), the touch screen driver must be
installed in the device in order to operate the touch screen. The corresponding drivers can be
downloaded from the download area on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com). The
touch screen should be calibrated while installing the driver.
The first time the touch screen is used, it must be calibrated once in the customer application for
the existing device and project.
4. Screen rotation
It is possible to rotate the image content by 90° using the graphic driver's screen rotation function
(must support the function).
The graphics driver does not support the screen rotation function.
4.2 Windows CE
The graphics driver supports the screen rotation function. The touch screen must be recalibrated
after rotation 1 (manual restart or when prompted by the operating system).
Automation Runtime supports the screen rotation function. When developing a project using
Automation Studio 2.7.x or 3.0.x, you can select the orientation of the display before getting
started.
5.1 Backlight
The lifespan of the backlight is specified in "Half Brightness Time". An operating time of 50,000
hours would mean that the display brightness would still be 50% after this time.
• Set the display brightness to the lowest value that is still comfortable for the eyes
• Use dark images
• Reducing the brightness by 50% can result in an approximate 50% increase of the half-
brightness time.
Commissioning
Chapter 3
Image sticking is the "burning in" of a static image on a display after being displayed for a
prolonged period of time. However, this does not only occur with static images. Image sticking
is known in technical literature as the "burn-in effect", "image retention", "memory effect",
"memory sticking" or "ghost image".
• Area type: This is seen with a dark gray image. The effect disappears if the display is
switched off for a longer period of time.
• Line type: This can cause lasting damage.
• Static images
• Screensaver not enabled
• Sharp contrast transitions (e.g. black / white)
• High ambient temperatures
• Operation outside of the specifications
Chapter 4 • Software
Information:
The following diagrams and BIOS menu items including descriptions refer to BIOS
version 1.14. It is therefore possible that these diagrams and BIOS descriptions do
not correspond with the installed BIOS version.
BIOS stands for "Basic Input Output System". It is the most basic standardized communication
between the user and the system (hardware). A B&R-modified BIOS from Insyde is used in the
Power Panel devices.
BIOS setup lets you modify basic system configuration settings. These settings are saved in
CMOS RAM.
The CMOS RAM is a nonvolatile, battery-backed memory that retains information when power
Chapter 4
Software
is not applied to the Power Panel.
BIOS is immediately activated when switching on the power supply of the Power Panel.
BIOS reads the system configuration information in CMOS RAM, checks the system, and
configures it using the power-on self-test (POST).
Power Panel
Figure 267: BIOS summary screen for VGA, SVGA and XGA Power Panel devices
To deactivate this summary screen for VGA, SVGA and XGA variants, see "Miscellaneous
configuration" on page 416.
Power Panel
Figure 268: BIOS summary screen for QVGA Power Panel devices
To deactivate this summary screen for QVGA variants, see "Miscellaneous configuration" on
page 438.
To make changes in the BIOS setup, the DEL key must be pressed when booting the Power
Panel device as soon as the following message appears in the upper margin of the display
(during the POST):
If the message disappears before DEL has been pressed1) , then the Power Panel must be
booted again in order to enter BIOS setup.
Warning!
The following general rule applies: Only modify those settings that you completely
understand. On no account should settings be changed without a good reason. The
BIOS settings have been carefully chosen by B&R to guarantee ideal performance
and reliability. Even a seemingly minor change to the settings may cause the system
to become unstable.
Information:
The settings recommended by B&R can be loaded with "Load defaults". For a list of
the default values, see Section 1.5 "BIOS default values" on page 445.
Chapter 4
Software
The following keys1) help you navigate in BIOS setup:
Key Function
Cursor ↑ Moves to the previous item.
Cursor ↓ Go to the next item.
Cursor ← Moves to the previous item.
Cursor → Go to the next item.
ESC Exits the submenu.
Enter or press highlighted character Changes to the selected menu.
shortcut
F1 and ALT+H Opens up a help window that describes the possible values for the highlighted item. Press ESC to exit
the help window. In a help window, the cursor ↑, Cursor ↓, Home, End, Page Up, and Page Down
keys can be used to navigate when help texts are longer than the displayable area.
Home Jumps to the first BIOS menu item or object.
End Jumps to the last BIOS menu item or object.
ALT+Q and ALT+X Enters the BIOS main menu.
1) A USB keyboard is required to enter characters and operate BIOS setup pages.
Key Function
- (Minus) Decreases the numerical value or selects the previous parameter value.
+ (Plus) Increases the numerical value or selects the next parameter value.
1.3 BIOS settings for VGA, SVGA and XGA Power Panel devices
Information:
The BIOS default values can be found in the section 1.5 "BIOS default values" on
page 445.
Immediately after the DEL button is pressed during startup, the main BIOS setup menu appears.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
T. Time 12:30:25
D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
Chapter 4
Software
Set the current time in the RTC
The individual menu items are explained in detail in the following sections.
1.3.2 Time
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
T. Time 12:30:25
D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
TIMEthe
Set as current
HH:MM[:SS] (Seconds
time are optional)
in the RTC
The currently configured system time is displayed here. The time is buffered by a battery (CMOS
battery) after the Power Panel device has been switched off.
By selecting the item "Time" and the confirming by pressing Enter, or using the shortcut "A", you
can enter a new system time. The format HH:MM[:SS] must be entered as follows:
The entry can be made in three different ways using the keyboard:
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "Shift+ö" key to enter ":".
1.3.3 Date
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
T. Time 12:30:25
D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
Chapter 4
Software
Date: _
Datethe
Set as current
MM/DD/YYYY
time in the RTC
The current system date is displayed here. The date is buffered by a battery (CMOS battery)
after the Power Panel device has been switched off.
By selecting the item "Date" and the confirming by pressing Enter, or using the shortcut "B", you
can enter a new system date. The format MM:DD:YYYY must be entered as shown in the
following example:
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "-" key (next to the Shift key) to enter "/".
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Motherboard Device Configuration
A. Drive Configuration
B. I/O Configuration
F. Video and Flat Panel Configuration
G. PCI Configuration
U. USB Configuration
T. Thermal Configuration
Set configuration for Hard Drive, Floppy Drive, and Flash devices
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Drive Configuration
IDE Configuration
IDE BIOS Support: Enabled
DMA/UDMA BIOS Support: Enabled
Force mode for CF Card: Auto
Chapter 4
DMA/UDMA BIOS Display of the DMA/UDMA BIOS support None -
Software
support for the inserted CompactFlash card.
Force mode for CF The maximum data transfer mode to and Auto Configures the fastest mode supported by the
card from a CompactFlash card can be inserted CompactFlash card.
configured here.
PIO 0 to PIO 4 Manual configuration option for PIO mode.
Information: MDMA 0 to MDMA 2 Manual configuration option for MDMA mode.
If a mode is configured that is not UDMA 0 to UDMA 5 Manual configuration option for UDMA mode.
supported by the CompactFlash card,
then the fastest supported mode is
configured.
Floppy BIOS support Floppy support (USB) can be Enabled Floppy support activated.
activated/deactivated here.
Disabled Floppy support deactivated.
CD-ROM boot BIOS The CD-ROM boot BIOS support can be Enabled CD-ROM boot support activated.
support activated/deactivated here. Booting a connected USB
CD-ROM drive is possible.
Disabled CD-ROM boot support deactivated.
USB BIOS support USB BIOS support can be Enabled USB BIOS support activated.
activated/deactivated here.
Disabled USB BIOS support deactivated.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Super I/O Configuration
COM C Configures the UART address range and Disabled No assignment. The serial interface is disabled.
the corresponding interrupt for the
external serial interface. 0x3f8 IRQ 4 Use this address range and interrupt.
0x2f8 IRQ 3
Information:
0x3e8 IRQ 4
Two ports cannot use the same
address range and interrupt. 0x2e8 IRQ 3
0x3f8 IRQ 12
0x2f8 IRQ 11
0x3e8 IRQ 12
0x2e8 IRO 11
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Graphics Configuration
Chapter 4
Software
Figure 276: Motherboard device configuration - video and flat panel configuration
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
PCI Configuration
aPCI Slots
1st Module ID: NONE
Type:
Status: FPGA NFOUND
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
PCI Configuration
Chapter 4
Software
Enable/Disable OHCI PCI header
OTG Turns the On-to-Go device on/off. Only Enabled Enables this function.
the PCI config space is activated in BIOS.
Disabled Disables this function.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Thermal Configuration
Temperatures
CPU Intern: 56°C
Board I/O: 42°C
Fan: 0RPM
CMOS Battery: OK
Warning!
The parameters in this screen are for system designers, service personnel, and
technically competent users only. Only modify those settings that you completely
understand.
Incorrectly setting "Memory optimization" values can cause instability and even
cause the entire system not to boot. If the PPC300 can no longer be booted, then the
mode/node switch must be set to 0-0 and the default BIOS values can be restored
by pushing the reset button three times (see section 1.5.8 "Restoring the default
BIOS values" on page 447).
Information:
More detailed information about the meaning and effects of the settings can also be
found in the corresponding user's manual for the processor.
Chapter 4
Software
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Memory and Cache Optimization
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
System Clock/PLL Configuration
Clock Mode
Clock Determined By: H/W Strapping
Chapter 4
multiplier).
Software
CPU multiplier The CPU multiplier can be selected with None -
this option.
233 MHz, 266 MHz, Manually setting the value.
Information: 300 MHz, 333 MHz,
366 MHz, 400 MHz,
This value can only be set if the BIOS 433 MHz, 466 MHz,
setting "Clock determined by" is set to 500 MHz
Manual.
RAM multiplier The RAM multiplier can be selected with None -
this option.
233 MHz, 266 MHz, Manually setting the value.
Information: 300 MHz, 333 MHz,
366 MHz, 400 MHz,
This value can only be set if the BIOS 433 MHz, 466 MHz,
setting "Clock determined by" is set to 500 MHz
Manual.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Power Management
ACPI available The ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Yes Enables this function.
Power Interface) option is an extended
PnP and power management function. No Disables this function.
S1 clocks The processor can be "stopped" with this Off Disables this function.
option.
On Enables this function.
CPU clock gating During power management, the clock Enabled Enables this function.
lines are turned off for devices connected
to the CPU. Disabled Disables this function.
Chipset clock gating During power management, the clock Enabled Enables this function.
lines are turned off for devices connected
to the chipset. Disabled Disables this function.
Power button This option determines how ACPI mode When the power button is pressed and held for 4
the Power button will function. seconds, the Power Panel is switched off without
shutting down the operating system.
Instant off Turns off immediately.
Power loss control This option determines what should occur Power-on The device turns back on.
after a power failure.
Stay off Device remains off.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Device Information
Switches
Mode/Node: 02h
Chapter 4
MTCX PX32 The MTCX firmware version is displayed None -
Software
here.
MTCX KCF The KCF (Key Configuration File) version None -
is displayed here.
BIOS The BIOS version is displayed here. None -
FACT The version of the factory settings is None -
displayed here.
Mode/Node Displays the current mode/node switch None -
position.
ETH The MAC address of the Ethernet None -
interface is displayed here.
Device ID Hex value for the device code of the None -
Power Panel device.
Comp. ID The compatibility code of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
Serial no. The serial number of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
Product name The product name of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Miscellaneous Configuration
PC Speaker Configuration
AC Beeper: Enabled
Secutity Option
Password: None
Chapter 4
Software
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Boot Order
CF card Info
Model Number: No CF Card
Capabilities:
Phy. Geometry:
Log. Geometry:
Chapter 4
Software
4 Hard drive
USB hard drive /
flash drive
None
Model number Displays the CompactFlash model ID. None -
Capabilities Displays the possible data transfer mode None -
speeds to and from an inserted
CompactFlash card.
Phy. geometry Displays the physical geometry of the None -
inserted CompactFlash card in cylinders,
heads and sectors.
Log. geometry Displays the logical geometry of the None -
inserted CompactFlash card in cylinders,
heads and sectors.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
T. Time 21:56:12
Info
D. Date 08/21/2006
Defaults set!
B. Motherboard Device Configuration
M. Memory an Cache Optimization
C. System Clock/PLL Configuration
P. Power Management
I. Device Information
H. Miscellaneous Configuration
O. Boot Order
L. Load Defaults
S. Save Values
Hit anyWithout
key to Exit
continue_
Q. Exit Without Save
X. Save values and Exit
Under this BIOS menu item (shortcut "L"), by pressing any key you can load
the values that were set at the time BIOS setup was opened. All changes made up to that point
are lost as a result.
The BIOS default values can also be restored without entering the BIOS setup. For procedure,
see Section 1.5.8 "Restoring the default BIOS values" on page 447.
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
T. Time 21:56:12
Info
D. Date 08/21/2006
Settings Saved!
B. Motherboard Device Configuration
M. Memory an Cache Optimization
C. System Clock/PLL Configuration
P. Power Management
I. Device Information
H. Miscellaneous Configuration
O. Boot Order
L. Load Defaults
S. Save Values
Hit anyWithout
key to Exit
continue_
Q. Exit Without Save
X. Save values and Exit
The BIOS values are saved using this menu item (shortcut "S") by pressing any key. The user
can then make additional settings or exit BIOS setup.
Chapter 4
Software
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
L. Load Defaults
BIOS setup can be exited by selecting "Yes" under this menu item (shortcut "Q") without saving
any changes that might have been made. The system is then automatically restarted.
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "z" key to enter "y".
XpressROM Setup
F1/ALT+H:Show Help ESC:Exit ALT+Q:Go to Main Menu ENTER:Select +/-:Choice
Main Menu
L. Load Defaults
If "Yes" is selected under this menu item (X shortcut), the system saves the settings,
automatically exits BIOS setup, and reboots the system.
Information:
Chapter 4
Software
If using a German keyboard, press the "z" key to enter "y".
Information:
The BIOS default values can be found in the section 1.5 "BIOS default values" on
page 445.
Immediately after the DEL button is pressed during startup, the main BIOS setup menu appears.
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
>>T. Time 12:30:25
D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
The individual menu items are explained in detail in the following sections.
1.4.2 Time
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
>>T. Time 12:30:25
D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
Chapter 4
Software
The currently configured system time is displayed here. The time is buffered by a battery (CMOS
battery) after the Power Panel device has been switched off.
By selecting the item "Time" and the confirming by pressing Enter, or using the shortcut "A", you
can enter a new system time. The format HH:MM[:SS] must be entered as follows:
The entry can be made in three different ways using the keyboard:
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "Shift+ö" key to enter ":".
1.4.3 Date
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
T. Time 12:30:25
>>D. Date 04/19/2007
L. Load Defaults
The current system date is displayed here. The date is buffered by a battery (CMOS battery)
after the Power Panel device has been switched off.
By selecting the item "Date" and the confirming by pressing Enter, or using the shortcut "B", you
can enter a new system date. The format MM:DD:YYYY must be entered as shown in the
following example:
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "-" key (next to the Shift key) to enter "/".
XpressROM Setup
Motherboard Device Configuration
>>A. Drive Configuration
B. I/O Configuration
F. Video and Flat Panel
G. PCI Configuration
U. USB Configuration
T. Thermal Configuration
Chapter 4
U USB configuration Configures USB settings.
Software
T Thermal configuration Display of temperatures.
R Return to main menu Exits the current page and returns to the BIOS main menu.
XpressROM Setup
Drive Configuration
IDE Configuration
IDE BIOS Support: Enabled
DMA/UDMA BIOS Support: Enabled
>>Force mode for CF Card: Auto
XpressROM Setup
I/O Configuration
Serial Port Configuration
>>COM A: Disabled
COM C: 0x3f8 IRQ 4
COM D: 0x2f8 IRQ 3
Chapter 4
Software
COM C Configures the UART address range and Disabled No assignment. The serial interface is disabled.
the corresponding interrupt for the
external serial interface. 0x3f8 IRQ 4 Use this address range and interrupt.
0x2f8 IRQ 3
Information:
0x3e8 IRQ 4
Two ports cannot use the same
address range and interrupt. 0x2e8 IRQ 3
0x3f8 IRQ 12
0x2f8 IRQ 11
0x3e8 IRQ 12
0x2e8 IRO 11
XpressROM Setup
Video and Flat Panel
>>Graphics Memory:008
Output display: Flat Panel
Figure 296: Motherboard device configuration - video and flat panel configuration
XpressROM Setup
PCI Configuration
PCI Interrupt Steering
>>PCI INTA#: IRQ 10
PCI INTB#: IRQ 11
PCI INTC#: IRQ 10
Chapter 4
Software
PCI INTD#: IRQ 11
aPCI Slots
1st Module ID: NONE
Type:
Status: FPGA NFOUND
XpressROM Setup
USB Configuration
USB 2.0 Settings
>>OHCI: Enabled
EHCI: Enabled
UDC: Disabled
OTG: Disabled
Overcurrent reporting: Disabled
Port 4 assignment: Host
OTG Turns the On-to-Go device on/off. Only Enabled Enables this function.
the PCI config space is activated in BIOS.
Disabled Disables this function.
XpressROM Setup
Thermal Configuration
Temperatures
CPU Intern: 51°C
Board I/O: 39°C
Fan: 0RPM
CMOS Battery: OK
Chapter 4
Software
Figure 299: Motherboard device configuration - thermal configuration
Warning!
The parameters in this screen are for system designers, service personnel, and
technically competent users only. Only modify those settings that you completely
understand.
Incorrectly setting "Memory optimization" values can cause instability and even
cause the entire system not to boot. If the Power Panel can no longer be booted,
then the default BIOS values can be restored by pushing the reset button three times
(see section 1.5.8 "Restoring the default BIOS values" on page 447).
Information:
More detailed information about the meaning and effects of the settings can also be
found in the corresponding user's manual for the processor.
XpressROM Setup
Memory and Cache Optimization
Cache Mode: Write-Back
Cache Allocate: Disabled
XpressROM Setup
System Clock/PLL Configuration
Clock Mode
>>Clock Determined By: H/W Strp.
Chapter 4
Software
BIOS setting Meaning Setting options Effect
Clock determined by The processor clock can be set with this H/W strapping Value is set automatically.
option.
Manual Value must be set manually (CPU multiplier, RAM
multiplier).
CPU multiplier The CPU multiplier can be selected with None -
this option.
233 MHz, 266 MHz, Manually setting the value.
Information: 300 MHz, 333 MHz,
366 MHz, 400 MHz,
This value can only be set if the BIOS 433 MHz, 466 MHz,
setting "Clock determined by" is set to 500 MHz
Manual.
RAM multiplier The RAM multiplier can be selected with None -
this option.
233 MHz, 266 MHz, Manually setting the value.
Information: 300 MHz, 333 MHz,
366 MHz, 400 MHz,
This value can only be set if the BIOS 433 MHz, 466 MHz,
setting "Clock determined by" is set to 500 MHz
Manual.
XpressROM Setup
Power Management
>>BIOS PM at Boot: Disabled
ACPI available The ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Yes Enables this function.
Power Interface) option is an extended
PnP and power management function. No Disables this function.
S1 clocks The processor can be "stopped" with this Off Disables this function.
option.
On Enables this function.
CPU clock gating During power management, the clock Enabled Enables this function.
lines are turned off for devices connected
to the CPU. Disabled Disables this function.
Chipset clock gating During power management, the clock Enabled Enables this function.
lines are turned off for devices connected
to the chipset. Disabled Disables this function.
Power button This option determines how ACPI mode When the power button is pressed and held for 4
the Power button will function. seconds, the Power Panel is switched off without
shutting down the operating system.
Instant off Turns off immediately.
Power loss control This option determines what should occur Power-on The device turns back on.
after a power failure.
Stay off Device remains off.
XpressROM Setup
Device Information
Version
MTCX FPGA: V1.00
MTCX PX32: V1.14
MTCX KCF : V0.00
BIOS: V1.14
Fact: V2.01
Switches
Mode/Node: 02h
Factory Settings
Device ID: 000023BA
Comp. ID: 0000
Serial Nr: 91460168421
Product Name: 4PP420.0571-65
User ID: 00000000
Chapter 4
Software
is displayed here.
BIOS The BIOS version is displayed here. None -
Fact The version of the factory settings is None -
displayed here.
Mode/Node Displays the current mode/node switch None -
position.
Device ID Hex value for the device code of the None -
Power Panel device.
Comp. ID The compatibility code of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
Serial no. The serial number of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
Product name The product name of the Power Panel None -
device is displayed here.
User ID Displays the User ID. None -
This 8 digit hex value can be freely
assigned by the user (e.g. to give the
device a unique ID) and can only be
changed with using the "B&R Control
Center" via the ADI driver.
XpressROM Setup
Miscellaneous
Boot Logo Configuration
>>Boot Logo: Enabled
Clear Boot Logo: Enabled
Boot Logo Timeout: 00000
PC Speaker Configuration
AC Beeper: Enabled
Security Option
Password: None
Boot logo timeout Defines the duration of the "Press DEL for 0 No waiting.
Setup" message on the display and how
much time the user has to change to the
BIOS configuration. 1-65535 [milliseconds] The manually set value in milliseconds
that must pass before the boot process
Information: continues.
Chapter 4
Software
XpressROM Setup
Boot Order
Boot Order Configuration
>>1. USB Floppy Disk
2. USB CD-ROM Drive
3. Hard Drive
4. USB Hard/Flash Drv.
CF Card Info
Model:No CF Card
Cap.:
Phy.:
Log.:
Chapter 4
Software
4 Hard drive
USB hard drive /
flash drive
None
Model number Displays the CompactFlash model ID. None -
Capabilities Displays the possible data transfer mode None -
speeds to and from an inserted
CompactFlash card.
Phy. geometry Displays the physical geometry of the None -
inserted CompactFlash card in cylinders,
heads and sectors.
Log. geometry Displays the logical geometry of the None -
inserted CompactFlash card in cylinders,
heads and sectors.
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
T. Time 00:02:56
D. Date 03/12/2007
Defaults set!
Under this BIOS menu item (shortcut "L"), by pressing any key you can load
the values that were set at the time BIOS setup was opened. All changes made up to that point
are lost as a result.
The BIOS default values can also be restored without entering the BIOS setup. For procedure,
see Section 1.5.8 "Restoring the default BIOS values" on page 447.
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
T. Time 00:02:56
D. Date 03/12/2007
Settings Saved!
The BIOS values are saved using this menu item (shortcut "S") by pressing any key. The user
can then make additional settings or exit BIOS setup.
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
Chapter 4
Software
T. Time 00:02:56
D. Exit Without Save
Are you sure you want to
B. exit without Saving? on
M. >>No Yes
C.
P. Power Management
I. Device Information
H. Micellaneous Configuration
O. Boot Order
L. Load Defaults
BIOS setup can be exited by selecting "Yes" under this menu item (shortcut "Q") without saving
any changes that might have been made. The system is then automatically restarted.
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "z" key to enter "y".
XpressROM Setup
Main Menu
T. Time 00:02:56
D. Save Values and Exit
Are you sure you want to
B. save all values and exit? on
M. >>No Yes
C.
P. Power Management
I. Device Information
H. Micellaneous Configuration
O. Boot Order
L. Load Defaults
If "Yes" is selected under this menu item (X shortcut), the system saves the settings,
automatically exits BIOS setup, and reboots the system.
Information:
If using a German keyboard, press the "z" key to enter "y".
The BIOS default values are the BIOS settings that were already configured when the PPC300
was delivered. The BIOS default values are identical in all variants (QVGA, VGA, SVGA and
XGA).
Chapter 4
Software
Contrast Auto
Brightness Auto
PCI Configuration
PCI INTA# IRQ 10
PCI INTB# IRQ 11
PCI INTC# IRQ 10
PCI INTD# IRQ 11
USB configuration
OHCI Enabled
EHCI Enabled
UDC Disabled
OTG Disabled
Overcurrent reporting Disabled
Port 4 assignment Host
Thermal configuration
CPU internal -
Board I/O -
This BIOS page is only provided for information purposes - therefore, no default BIOS values are
available.
Chapter 4
In the event that the BIOS settings become incorrectly defined (e.g. USB Keyboard Support
Software
disabled, crash during operating system startup), the BIOS default values can be restored using
the following procedure.
Procedure:
The following Power Panel device software and firmware can be updated:
To protect CMOS data, a CMOS backup has been integrated into BIOS. If the BIOS setup was
ended using "Save values and exit" and the Power Panel device was successfully restarted, then
the CMOS data is burned to flash memory. If the CMOS checksum is incorrect during startup
(battery dead) or the Power Panel device cannot be booted correctly three times consecutively,
then the salvaged data from flash memory is copied again to CMOS. Setup is back to its original
state, except for the time.
Chapter 4
Software
1 Freely available
2 Freely available
3 Freely available
4 Freely available
5 Freely available
6 Freely available
7 Freely available
In addition, the I/O addresses that were selected for additional functions (COM, etc.) are
assigned.
Interrupt Resource
IRQ 0 System timer
IRQ 1 Keyboard (Legacy USB emulation)
IRQ 2 2nd PIC IRQ cascade
IRQ 3 COM2 1)
IRQ 4 COM1 1)
IRQ 5 PCI configuration space
IRQ 6 Disk drive
IRQ 7 PCI configuration space
IRQ 8 RTC (real-time clock)
IRQ 9 PCI configuration space
IRQ 10 PCI configuration space
IRQ 11 COM3 1)
IRQ 12 PS/2 mouse (Legacy USB emulation)
IRQ 13 FPU (co-processor)
IRQ 14 Primary IDE (primary hard disk)
IRQ 15 PCI configuration space
Chapter 4
Software
B&R Automation Runtime guarantees a uniform runtime environment for Automation Studio
programs on all target systems. This ensures uniform programming and operation on all devices.
Automation Runtime possesses a multitasking operating system adapted specially for use with
control technology. The cycle time for your application can be separated among several task
classes. Automation Runtime ensures that all application programs are executed within defined
time periods, proving itself to be a configurable, deterministic real-time multitasking system.
An extensive project can be divided into small individual tasks. This way of working increases
modularity and makes it much easier to maintain projects.
When switching on a Power Panel 300/400 device, a summary screen displays the most
important parameters of an Automation Runtime Power Panel device:
4PP420.1043-75
PX32: V01.11 Boot BIOS: V01.14
FPGA: V01.00
FACT: V02.01 Device ID: 23BDh
2.2 Control and visualization with the Power Panel 300 device
The visualization project runs on the Power Panel 300. Serial RS232 or Ethernet TCP/IP
provides the communication to the controller system. Flexible programming with frame drivers
or Ethernet socket services allows a connection to be made to any control system. I/O
peripherals and drives are connected to the controller.
Power Panel
RS232 or Ethernet
Control system
X20 System
Chapter 4
Software
Compact
X20 System I/O System
Remote I/O systems
ACOPOS ACOPOS
Drive technology
Control program and visualization run on the Power Panel 400. I/O peripherals and drives are
connected via CAN, X2X and POWERLINK. Other Power Panel 300 units are connected as
terminals via Ethernet TCP/IP. The central data storage occurs on the Power Panel 400.
Visualization &
Operation
Ethernet
Control system
Visualization & Operation
Compact
X20 System I/O System
ACOPOS ACOPOS
Drive technology
Figure 312: Power Panel 400 with, e.g. Power Panel 300 terminals
A CompactFlash is required in the Power Panel 300 and Power Panel 400 terminal devices.
The following Power Panel Automation Runtime device software and firmware can be updated:
Chapter 4
Software
3. Upgrade information
Information:
Starting with BIOS Version V1.16, Automation Runtime devices can boot using
bootable USB media (USB floppy drives, USB flash drives, etc.) in Mode/Node
switch setting "00".
Information:
The upgrade can be made using a bootable medium or via the B&R control center.
See the B&R ADI help for more information about upgrading via the B&R Control
Center.
Information:
Individually saved BIOS settings are deleted when upgrading the BIOS.
3.1.2 Procedure
Information:
In MS-DOS, Win95 and Win98, a blank HD disk can be made bootable using the
command line command "sys a:" or "format a: /s".
Information concerning creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP cab be found on
page 465.
Information concerning creating a USB flash drive for a B&R upgrade can be found
on page 467.
• Copy the contents of the *.zip file to the bootable media. If the B&R upgrade was already
added when the bootable media was created using the B&R Embedded OS Installer, then
this step is not necessary.
• Connect the bootable media to the Power Panel and reboot the device. See section
"Motherboard device configuration - drive configuration" on page 405 for the necessary
settings for the Power Panel device when booting from a diskette.
Chapter 4
Software
• The following start menu will be shown after booting.
1. Update BIOS
2. Save BIOS
3. Exit
Enter a choice:_
Information:
Settings that have been changed in BIOS setup must be set again after the
update.
The update process may not be interrupted, as the Power Panel could no longer
be started, and would have to be sent to B&R for repair. Try to repeat an
interrupted update process WITHOUT restarting the Power Panel, e.g. by starting
the batch file UPDBIOS.BAT directly.
2 Save BIOS BIOS is automatically saved in the SAVED directory.
Information:
It's necessary to have up to 256 KB of free space on the disk.
3 Exit Returns to the shell (MS-DOS).
Information:
If you do not press a button within 5 seconds, then step 1 "Update BIOS" is
automatically carried out and the Power Panel is automatically updated.
A current MTCX Firmware (MTCX FPGA and MTCX PX32) upgrade can be downloaded directly
from the service portal on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
3.2.1 Procedure
Information:
In MS-DOS, Win95 and Win98, a blank HD disk can be made bootable using the
command line command "sys a:" or "format a: /s".
Information concerning creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP cab be found on
page 465.
Information concerning creating a USB flash drive for a B&R upgrade can be found
on page 467.
• Copy the contents of the *.zip file to the bootable media. If the B&R upgrade was already
added when the bootable media was created using the B&R Embedded OS Installer, then
this step is not necessary.
Chapter 4
Software
• Connect the bootable media to the Power Panel and reboot the device.
• A boot menu with the following options is displayed after booting:
Enter a choice:_
Concerning point 1:
The MTCX Firmware FPGA and PX32 is automatically updated (default after 5 sec).
Warning!
The upgrade procedure must not be interrupted! Otherwise, the Power Panel may
no longer restart, and must be sent to B&R for repair. Try to repeat an interrupted
upgrade process WITHOUT restarting the Power Panel, e.g. by starting the batch file
UPDMTCX.BAT directly.
Concerning point 2:
Return to the shell (MS-DOS).
A software tool for backing up or upgrading aPCI firmware can be downloaded directly from the
service portal of the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
3.3.1 Procedure
The following steps should be taken to upgrade the aPCI module firmware:
Information:
In MS-DOS, Win95 and Win98, a blank HD disk can be made bootable using the
command line command "sys a:" or "format a: /s".
Information concerning creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP cab be found on
page 465.
Information concerning creating a USB flash drive for a B&R upgrade can be found
on page 467.
• Copy the contents of the *.zip file to the bootable media. If the B&R upgrade was already
added when the bootable media was created using the B&R Embedded OS Installer, then
this step is not necessary.
Chapter 4
Software
• If there are already aPCI modules connected to the Power Panel and BIOS V1.04 is
installed, then the file name can be determined automatically by XFLASH.EXE.
Otherwise, the filename is queried by XFLASH.EXE or a default file name is used:
"apci1.rom" for aPCI slot 1, "apci2.rom" for aPCI slot 2 -> the aPCI firmware file must be
renamed beforehand!
Information:
The appropriate aPCI firmware files are available from B&R.
• Connect the bootable media to the Power Panel and reboot the device. See section
"Motherboard device configuration - drive configuration" on page 405 for Power Panel
devices for the necessary settings for the Power Panel device when booting from a
diskette.
• The following start menu will be shown after booting:
Enter a choice:_
Information:
According to the inserted modules, the aPCI FPGA firmware files are searched
for automatically.
2 Update FPGA firmware of aPCI slot 1 Only firmware from aPCI slot 1 is updated.
Information:
If no aPCI module is present, the aPCI FPGA firmware file must be renamed
"apci1.pci" (for aPCI slot 1) before updating.
3 Update FPGA firmware of aPCI slot 2 Only firmware from aPCI slot 2 is updated.
Information:
If no aPCI module is present, the aPCI FPGA firmware file must be renamed
"apci2.pci" (for aPCI slot 2) before updating.
4 Save FPGA firmware of both aPCI slots Firmware for both aPCI slots are automatically saved.
Information:
It's necessary to have up to 640 KB of free space on the disk.
5 Exit Returns to the shell (MS-DOS).
Information:
If you do not press a button within 5 seconds, then step 1 "Update FPGA firmware
automatically" is automatically carried out and the Power Panel is automatically
updated.
A software tool for updating, backing up, or deleting the user boot logo can be downloaded
directly from the service portal of the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
3.4.1 Procedure
The following steps should be taken to update, save or delete a user boot logo:
Information:
In MS-DOS, Win95 and Win98, a blank HD disk can be made bootable using the
command line command "sys a:" or "format a: /s".
Information concerning creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP cab be found on
page 465.
Information concerning creating a USB flash drive for a B&R upgrade can be found
on page 467.
• Copy the contents of the *.zip file to the bootable media. If the B&R upgrade was already
added when the bootable media was created using the B&R Embedded OS Installer, then
this step is not necessary.
• Create the user boot logo according to section 3.4.2 "Guidelines for creating a user boot
logo" on page 464 and copy to the bootable media.
• Connect the bootable media to the Power Panel and reboot the device. See section
"Motherboard device configuration - drive configuration" on page 405 for the necessary
settings for the Power Panel device when booting from a diskette.
Chapter 4
Software
• The following start menu will be shown after booting.
Enter a choice:_
Information:
It's necessary to have up to 192 KB of free space on the disk.
4 Delete BIOS boot logo An existing user boot logo is deleted in the flash.
5 Exit Returns to the shell (MS-DOS).
Information:
If you do not press a button within 5 seconds, then step 1 "Update BIOS User Boot
Logo" is automatically carried out and the Power Panel is automatically updated.
To update the user boot logo, a bitmap must be created according to the following guidelines and
then copied to the user boot logo upgrade disk:
1) A Windows bitmap with a maximum of 256 colors must be created with the appropriate
resolution for the Power Panel: 320x240 (QVGA), 640x480 (VGA), 800x600 (SVGA) or
1024x768 (XGA). The bitmap is not allowed to be compressed.
2) Since status messages are output on the top of the display when booting the Power Panel,
there should not be any user boot logo pixels positioned here in the bitmap (approximately
10 pixel stripes), as these will be cross-faded. These status messages use bitmap palette
index 0 as the background color and index 7 as the foreground color (starting from BIOS
V1.05; index 63 with older versions).
3) Using the utility USERLOGO.EXE, the bitmap file must then be converted into a ROM file
that can be read by BIOS (please refer to the online help for the utility for more instructions
about this).
4) The userlogo.rom file created by the utility is only permitted to have a maximum size of
192 KB. If this size is exceeded, a warning appears. The user can e.g. reduce the details in
the Windows bitmap in order not to exceed the maximum byte size.
Chapter 4
Software
• Then select the checkbox "Create an MS-DOS startup disk", press "Start" and
acknowledge the warning message with "OK".
After creating the startup disk, some of the files must be deleted because of the size of the
update.
When doing this, all files (hidden, system files, etc.) must be shown on the diskette.
In Explorer, go to the "tools" menu, select "folder options..." and open the "view" tab - now
deactivate the option "hide protected operating system files (recommended)" (activated as
default) and deactivate the option "show hidden files and folders".
before after
Now all files (marked) except Command.com, IO.sys and MSDOS.sys can be deleted.
3.6 Creating a bootable USB flash drive for B&R upgrade files
When used in connection with a B&R industrial PC, it is possible to upgrade BIOS from one of
the USB flash drives available from B&R. To do this, the USB flash drive must be prepared
accordingly. This is done with the B&R Embedded OS Installer, which can be downloaded for
free from the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
3.6.1 Requirements
The following peripherals are required for creating a bootable USB flash drive:
3.6.2 Procedure
Chapter 4
Software
• Enter the path to the MS-DOS operating system files. If the files are part of a ZIP archive,
then click on the button By ZIP file.... If the files are stored in a directory on the hard drive,
then click on the button By folder....
• In the B&R Upgrade text box, it's also possible to enter the path to the ZIP file for the
B&R Upgrade Disk and select the file.
• Click on the Start action button in the toolbar.
Figure 322: Creating a USB flash drive for B&R upgrade files
Information concerning creating an MS-DOS boot diskette can be found in section 3.5 "Creating
a DOS boot diskette in Windows XP" on page 465. Then the files from the diskette are to be
copied to your hard drive.
When used in connection with a B&R industrial PC, it is possible to upgrade BIOS from one of
the CompactFlash cards available from B&R. To do this, the CompactFlash card must be
prepared accordingly. This is done with the B&R Embedded OS Installer, which can be
downloaded for free from the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
3.7.1 Requirements
The following peripherals are required for creating a bootable CompactFlash card:
• CompactFlash card
• B&R Industrial PC
• B&R Embedded OS Installer (V3.10 or higher)
3.7.2 Procedure
Chapter 4
then click on the button By ZIP file.... If the files are stored in a directory on the hard drive,
Software
then click on the button By folder....
• In the B&R Upgrade text box, it's also possible to enter the path to the ZIP file for the
B&R Upgrade Disk and select the file.
• Click on the Start action button in the toolbar.
Information concerning creating an MS-DOS boot diskette can be found in section 3.5 "Creating
a DOS boot diskette in Windows XP" on page 465. Then the files from the diskette are to be
copied to your hard drive.
Chapter 4
Software
Microsoft Windows CE 5.0 Professional plus, English; for Power Panel 400 BIOS;
Order CompactFlash separately (min. 128 MB).
5SWWCE.0821-ENG WinCE6.0 Pro PP300 LX800
Microsoft Windows CE 6.0 Professional, English, including license; for PP300 BIOS devices
5PP320.0571-29, 5PP320.0571-39, 5PP320.0573-39, 5PP320.1043-39, 5PP320.1214-39,
5PP320.1505-39, order CompactFlash separately (at least 128 MB).
5SWWCE.0822-ENG WinCE6.0 Pro PP400 LX800
Microsoft Windows CE 6.0 Professional, English; for Power Panel 400 BIOS;
Order CompactFlash separately (min. 128 MB).
B&R Windows CE is an operating system which is optimally tailored to B&R's devices. It includes
only the functions and modules which are required by each device. This makes this operating
system extremely robust and stable. A further advantage of B&R Windows CE compared to other
operating systems are the low licensing costs.
Detailed information about Windows CE for B&R devices can be downloaded in the download
area on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
Detailed information about Windows CE for B&R devices can be downloaded in the download
area on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
Chapter 4
Software
Compatible with Wonderware Yes
Serial interfaces for any use 1
4.5 Requirements
The device must fulfill the following criteria to be able run the Windows CE operating system.
4.6 Installation
The B&R Embedded OS Installer allows you to install existing B&R Windows CE images. The
four files (NK.BIN, BLDR, LOGOXRES.BMP, and LOGOQVGA.BMP) must be provided from an
already functioning B&R Windows CE installation.
The B&R Embedded OS Installer can be downloaded from the download area on the B&R
homepage (www.br-automation.com). Further information is available in the online help for the
B&R Embedded OS Installer.
Windows XP Embedded is the modular version of the desktop operating system Windows XP
Professional. Windows XP Embedded is based on the same binary files as Windows XP
Professional and is optimally tailored to the hardware being used. In other words, only the
Chapter 4
Software
functions and modules required by the respective device are included. Windows XP Embedded
is also based on the same reliable code as Windows XP Professional. It provides industry with
leading reliability, improvements in security and performance, and the latest technology for Web
browsing and extensive device support.
The feature list shows the most important device functions in Windows XP Embedded with
Feature Pack 2007 (FP2007).
Function Present
Enhanced write filter (EWF) ✓
File Based Write Filter ✓
Page file configurable
Administrator account ✓
User account configurable
Explorer shell ✓
Function Present
Registry Filter ✓
Internet Explorer 6.0 + SP2 ✓
Internet information service (IIS) -
Terminal service ✓
Windows Firewall ✓
MSN-Explorer -
Outlook Express -
Administrative Tools ✓
Remote Desktop ✓
Remote Assistance -
.NET Framework -
ASP.NET -
Codepages/User Locale/Keyboard ✓
Disk Management Service ✓
Windows Installer Service ✓
Class Installer ✓
CoDevice Installer ✓
Media Player -
DirectX -
Accessories ✓
Number of fonts 89
5.3 Installation
Brief instructions for creating your own Windows XP Embedded images or a suitable Target
Designer export file can be downloaded from the download area on the B&R homepage
(www.br-automation.com).
Windows XP Embedded Standard 2009 is the modular version of the desktop operating system
Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 3. Windows XP Embedded Standard 2009 is based
on the same binary files as Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 3 and is optimally
tailored to the hardware being used. In other words, only the functions and modules required by
Chapter 4
Software
the respective device are included. Windows XP Embedded Standard 2009 is also based on the
same reliable code as Windows XP Professional with SP3. It provides industry with leading
reliability, improvements in security and performance, and the latest technology for Web
browsing and extensive device support.
The feature list shows the most important device functions in Windows Embedded Standard
2009.
Function Present
Enhanced write filter (EWF) ✓
File Based Write Filter ✓
Page file Configurable
Administrator account ✓
User account Configurable
Explorer shell ✓
Registry filter ✓
Internet Explorer 7.0 ✓
Internet information service (IIS) -
Terminal service ✓
Windows Firewall ✓
MSN-Explorer -
Outlook Express -
Administrative Tools ✓
Remote Desktop ✓
Remote Assistance -
.NET Framework -
ASP.NET -
Local Network Bridge ✓
Codepages/User Locale/Keyboard ✓
Disk Management Service ✓
Windows Installer Service ✓
Class Installer ✓
CoDevice Installer ✓
Media Player 6.4 ✓
DirectX 9.0c ✓
Accessories ✓
Number of fonts 89
6.3 Installation
Upon request, Windows Embedded Standard 2009 can be preinstalled at B&R Austria on a
suitable CompactFlash card (min. 1GB). The PP300/400 system is then automatically
configured after it has been switched on for the first time. This procedure takes approximately 30
minutes, and the device will be rebooted a number of times.
6.4 Drivers
All drivers required for operation are preinstalled on the operating system. If an older driver
version is installed, the latest version can be downloaded from the B&R homepage (www.br-
automation.com) and installed. A potentially activated "Enhanced Write Filter (EWF)" must be
taken into consideration.
The touch screen driver must be manually installed in order to operate Automation Panel 800 or
Automation Panel 900 touch screen devices. The driver can be downloaded from the download
area on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com). A potentially activated "Enhanced
Write Filter (EWF)" must be taken into consideration.
Information:
Required drivers can only be downloaded from the B&R homepage, not from
manufacturers' pages.
Chapter 4
Software
The ADI (Automation Device Interface) driver enables access to specific functions of B&R
devices. Settings for this device can be read and edited using the B&R Control Center applet in
the control panel.
Chapter 4
Software
Figure 327: ADI Control Center screenshots (Version 1.50) - example
A detailed description of the Control Center can be found in the integrated online help.
The B&R Automation Device Interface (ADI) driver (also contains Control Center) can be
downloaded for free from the download area on the B&R homepage (www.br-
automation.com).
The equalizer makes it possible to adjust the strength of the video signal to the SDL cable length.
This allows you to improve the visual representation on the display.
The value is optimally defined for the cable length when using the "Automatic setting".
The equalizer value can only be changed if the function is supported by Automation Panel 900
(starting with Panel Firmware version 1.04 or higher) and if MTCX PX32 version 1.54 or higher
is installed. Otherwise, the dialog fields are disabled.
Chapter 4
Software
2. Overview of standards
The Power Panel 300/400 devices collectively meet the following standards:
Standard Description
EN 55011 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), radio disturbance product standard, industrial, scientific, and
Class A, B medical high-frequency devices (ISM devices), limit values and measurement procedure; group 1
(devices that do not create HF during material processing) and group 2 (devices that create HF during
material processing)
EN 55022 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), radio disturbance characteristics, information technology
Class A, B equipment (ITE devices), limits and methods of measurement
EN 55024 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), immunity characteristics, information technology equipment (ITE
Class A or B devices), limits and methods of measurement
EN 60060-2 High-voltage test techniques - part 2: Measuring systems
EN 60068-2-1 Environmental testing - part 2: Tests; test A: Cold
EN 68068-2-2 Environmental testing - part 2: Tests; test B: Dry heat
EN 60068-2-3 Environmental testing - part 2: Tests; test and guidance: Damp heat, constant
EN 60068-2-6 Environmental testing - part 2: Tests; test: Vibration (sinusoidal)
Standards and
certifications
Chapter 5
Standard Description
EN 61000-4-3 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-3: Testing and measuring techniques; radiated radio-
frequency electromagnetic field immunity test
EN 61000-4-4 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-4: Testing and measuring techniques; electrical fast
transient/burst immunity test
EN 61000-4-5 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-5: Testing and measuring techniques; surge immunity
test
EN 61000-4-6 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-6: Testing and measuring techniques; immunity to
conducted disturbances, induced by radio-frequency fields
EN 61000-4-8 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-8: Testing and measuring techniques; power frequency
magnetic field immunity test
EN 61000-4-11 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-11: Testing and measuring techniques; voltage dips,
short interruptions and voltage variations immunity tests
EN 61000-4-12 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) - part 4-12: Testing and measuring techniques; oscillatory waves
immunity test
EN 61000-6-2 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), generic immunity standard - part 2: industrial environments (EN
(EN 50082-2) 50082-2 has been replaced by EN 61000-6-2)
EN 61000-6-4 Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC), generic emission standard - part 2: industrial environments (EN
(EN 50081-2) 50081-2 has been replaced by EN 61000-6-4)
EN 61131-2 Product standard, programmable logic controllers - part 2: Equipment requirements and tests
IEC 61131-2
NEMA 250 Type 4X UL protection against sprayed water
UL 508 Industrial control equipment (UL = Underwriters Laboratories)
47 CFR Federal Communications Commission (FCC), 47 CFR Part 15 Subpart B Class A
3. Emission requirements
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 55011 / EN 55022 EN 61000-6-4 EN 55011 class A EN 55022 class A
Power mains connections 79 dB (µV) 79 dB (µV) 79 dB (µV)
150 kHz - 500 kHz Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value
66 dB (µV) 66 dB (µV) 66 dB (µV)
Average Average Average
Power mains connections 73 dB (µV) 73 dB (µV) 73 dB (µV)
500 kHz - 30 MHz Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value
60 dB (µV) 60 dB (µV) 60 dB (µV)
Average Average Average
Other connections 97 - 87 dB (µV) and
150 kHz - 500 kHz 53 - 43 dB (µA)
Standards and
Quasi-peak value
certifications
- -
Chapter 5
84 - 74 dB (µV) and
40 - 30 dB (µA)
Average
Other connections 87 dB (µV) and 43 dB (µA)
500 kHz - 30 MHz Quasi-peak value
- -
74 dB (µV) and 30 dB (µA)
Average
Table 192: Test requirements - Network-related emissions for industrial areas (Forts.)
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 55011 / EN 55022 EN 61000-6-4 EN 55011 class A EN 55022 class A
30 MHz - 230 MHz < 40 dB (µV/m) < 40 dB (µV/m) < 40 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value
230 MHz - 1 GHz < 47 dB (µV/m) < 47 dB (µV/m) < 47 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value Quasi-peak value
Test carried out according to Limits according to
EN 55011 / EN 55022 EN 61131-2
30 MHz - 230 MHz < 40 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
230 MHz - 1 GHz < 47 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
Test carried out Limits according to 47 CFR Part
15 Subpart B class A
30 MHz - 88 MHz < 90 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
88 MHz - 216 MHz < 150 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
216 MHz - 960 MHz < 210 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
>960 MHz < 300 dB (µV/m)
measured at a distance of 10 m Quasi-peak value
Criteria A:
The operating equipment must continue to work as intended during the test. There should be
no interference in the operating behavior and no system failures below a minimum operating
quality as defined by the manufacturer.
Criteria B:
The operating equipment must continue to work as intended after the test. There should be no
interference in the operating behavior and no system failures below a minimum operating quality
as defined by the manufacturer.
Criteria C:
A temporary function failure is permitted when the function restores itself, or the function can be
restored by activating configuration and control elements.
Criteria D:
Impairment or failure of the function, which can no longer be established (operating equipment
destroyed).
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-2 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
Contact discharge to powder- ±4 kV, 10 discharges, ±4 kV, 10 discharges, ±4 kV, 10 discharges,
coated and bare metal housing criteria B criteria B criteria B
parts
Discharge through the air to plastic ±8 kV, 10 discharges, ±8 kV, 10 discharges, ±8 kV, 10 discharges,
housing parts criteria B criteria B criteria B
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-3 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
Housing, completely wired 80 MHz - 1 GHz, 10 V/m, 80% 80 MHz - 1 GHz, 1.4 - 2 GHz, 80 MHz - 1 GHz, 1.4 - 2 GHz,
amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, 10 V/m, 80% amplitude 3 V/m, 80% amplitude modulation
length 3 seconds, criteria A modulation with 1 kHz, length 3 with 1 kHz, length 3 seconds,
seconds, criteria A criteria A
800-960 MHz (GSM), 10 V/m,
pulse modulation with 50% duty
cycle, criteria A
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-4 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
AC power I/O ±2 kV, criteria B - ±1 kV, criteria B
AC power inputs - ±2 kV, criteria B -
AC power outputs - ±1 kV, criteria B -
DC power I/O >10 m 1) ±2 kV, criteria B - ±0.5 kV, criteria B
DC power inputs >10 m - ±2 kV, criteria B -
DC power outputs >10 m - ±1 kV, criteria B -
Functional ground connections,
±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B ±0.5 kV, criteria B
signal lines and I/Os >3 m
Unshielded AC I/O >3 m - ±2 kV, criteria B -
Analog I/O ±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B -
4.4 Surges
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-5 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
AC power I/O, L to L ±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B
AC power I/O, L to PE ±2 kV, criteria B ±2 kV, criteria B ±2 kV, criteria B
DC power I/O, L+ to L-, >10 m ±0.5 kV, criteria B - -
DC power I/O, L to PE, >10 m ±0.5 kV, criteria B - ±0.5 kV, criteria B
DC power inputs, L+ to L- - ±0.5 kV, criteria B -
DC power inputs, L to PE - ±1 kV, criteria B -
DC power outputs, L+ to L- - ±0.5 kV, criteria B -
DC power outputs, L to PE - ±0.5 kV, criteria B -
Standards and
Signal connections >30 m ±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B ±1 kV, criteria B
certifications
Chapter 5
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-6 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
AC power I/O 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 10 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80%
amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz,
length 3 seconds, criteria A length 3 seconds, criteria A criteria A
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-6 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
DC power I/O 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 10 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80%
amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz,
length 3 seconds, criteria A length 3 seconds, criteria A criteria A
Functional ground connections 0.15 - 80 MHz, 10 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80%
amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, -
Length 3 seconds, criteria A length 3 seconds, criteria A
Signal connections >3 m 0.15 - 80 MHz, 10 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80% 150 kHz - 80 MHz, 3 V, 80%
amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz, amplitude modulation with 1 kHz,
Length 3 seconds, criteria A length 3 seconds, criteria A criteria A
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 61000-4-8 EN 61000-6-2 EN 61131-2 EN 55024
Test direction x, test in the field of
30 A/m, criteria A 30 A/m, criteria A 50 Hz, 1 A/m, criteria A
an induction coil 1 m x 1 m
Test direction y, test in the field of
30 A/m, criteria A 30 A/m, criteria A 50 Hz, 1 A/m, criteria A
an induction coil 1 m x 1 m
Test direction z, test in the field of
30 A/m, criteria A 30 A/m, criteria A 50 Hz, 1 A/m, criteria A
an induction coil 1 m x 1 m
Table 201: Test requirements - Voltage dips, fluctuations, and short-term interruptions
Standards and
certifications
Chapter 5
5. Mechanical conditions
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 60068-2-6 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M1 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M2 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M3
Vibration during transport: 10 sweeps for each axis, 10 sweeps for each axis, 10 sweeps for each axis,
Uninterrupted duty with moveable packaged packaged packaged
frequency in all 3 axes (x, y, z)
Frequency Limit value Frequency Limit value Frequency Limit value
2 - 9 Hz Amplitude 2 - 9 Hz Amplitude 2 - 8 Hz Amplitude
3.5 mm 3.5 mm 7.5 mm
9 - 200 Hz Acceleration 9 - 200 Hz Acceleration 8 - 200 Hz Acceleration
1g 1g 2g
200 - 500 Hz Acceleration 200 - 500 Hz Acceleration 200 - 500 Hz Acceleration
1.5 g 1.5 g 4g
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 60068-2-27 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M1 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M2 B&R
Pulse (half-sine) stress in all 3 axes Acceleration 10 g, Acceleration 30 g, Acceleration 30 g,
(x, y, z) Length 11 ms, each 3 shocks, Length 6 ms, each 3 shocks, Length 11 ms, each 3 shocks,
packaged packaged packaged
5.5 Toppling
certifications
Chapter 5
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 60068-2-31 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M1 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M2 EN 60721-3-2 class 2M3
Drop and topple Devices: Drop/topple Devices: Drop/topple Devices: Drop/topple
on each edge on each edge on each edge
Weight Required Weight Required Weight Required
<20 kg Yes <20 kg Yes <20 kg Yes
20 - 100 kg - 20 - 100 kg Yes 20 - 100 kg Yes
>100 kg - >100 kg - >100 kg Yes
Test carried out according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to Limits according to
EN 60068-2-32 EN 61131-2 EN 60721-3-2 class EN 60721-3-2 class EN 60721-3-2 class
2M1 2M2 2M3
Free fall Devices with delivery Devices packaged Devices packaged Devices packaged
packaging each with 5
fall tests
Weight Height Weight Height Weight Height Weight Height
<10 kg 1.0 m <20 kg 0.25 m <20 kg 1.2 m <20 kg 1.5 m
10 - 40 kg 0.5 m 20 - 100 0.25 m 20 - 100 1.0 m 20 - 100 1.2 m
kg kg kg
>40 kg 0.25 m >100 kg 0.1 m >100 kg 0.25 m >100 kg 0.5 m
Devices with product
packaging each with 5
fall tests
Weight Height
<10 kg 0.3 m
10 - 40 kg 0.3 m
>40 kg 0.25 m
Limits according to
B&R
Devices packaged
Weight Height
<40 kg 1m
6. Climate conditions
Table 210: Overview of limits and testing guidelines for temperature and humidity
approximately 17 hours
Standards and
certifications
Chapter 5
7. Safety
100 VAC
110 VAC
15%
120 VAC
+10%
200 VAC
230 VAC
240 VAC
400 VAC
8. Other tests
Table 224: Overview of limits and testing guidelines for other tests
9. International certifications
B&R products and services comply with applicable standards. They are international standards
from organizations such as ISO, IEC and CENELEC, as well as national standards from
organizations such as UL, CSA, FCC, VDE, ÖVE, etc. We give special consideration to the
reliability of our products in an industrial environment.
Certifications
USA and Canada All important B&R products are tested and listed by Underwriters Laboratories and
checked quarterly by a UL inspector.
This mark is valid for the USA and Canada and simplifies certification of your machines
and systems in these areas.
Europe All harmonized EN standards for the applicable guidelines are met.
Standards and
certifications
Chapter 5
Chapter 6 • Accessories
1. Overview
The lithium battery is needed for buffering the BIOS CMOS data, the real-time clock, and SRAM
data.
The battery is subject to wear and must be replaced when the battery power ("Bad" status) is
insufficient (see "Changing the battery" on page 528).
Information:
The following characteristics, features and limit values only apply to this accessory
and can deviate those specified for the entire device. For the entire device where
this accessory is installed, refer to the data provided specifically for the entire
device.
The technical data is current as of when this manual was printed. We reserve the
right to make changes.
Amount Component
1 or 4 Lithium batteries
This single row 3-pin terminal block is mainly used to connect the supply voltage.
0TB103.9
0TB103.91
Information:
The following characteristics, features and limit values only apply to this accessory
and can deviate those specified for the entire device. For the entire device where
this accessory is installed, refer to the data provided specifically for the entire
device.
The technical data is current as of when this manual was printed. We reserve the
Accessories
Amount Component
1 Supply plug in desired design.
Power Panel devices with keys are delivered with partially pre-labeled key legend strips (F1, F2,
etc.). The key legend strip slots are accessible on the back of the Power Panel device (above
and below).
Printable legend strips (A4 format) can be ordered from B&R (see table 234 "Order data - Legend
strip templates" on page 512). They can be printed using a standard laser printer (b/w or color)
in a temperature range from -40 to +125°C. A print template (available for Corel Draw version 7,
9 and 10) for the respective legend strip template can be downloaded from the B&R homepage
www.br-automation.com.
Accessories
Chapter 6
device.
5AC900.104X-02 Legend strips 3x 10.4" Horizontal1
Legend strip template for Power Panel 4PP480.1043-75. For 3
devices.
5AC900.150X-00 Legend strips 4x 15"
Legend strip template for Power Panel 4PP481.1505-75 and
4PP480.1505-75. For 4 devices.
Information:
The 5CFCRD.xxxx-04 CompactFlash cards are supported on B&R devices with
WinCE Version ≥ 6.0 or higher.
CompactFlash card
Accessories
Chapter 6
Caution!
A sudden loss of power can cause data to be lost! In very rare cases, the mass
memory may also become damaged.
Information:
The following characteristics, features and limit values only apply to this accessory
and can deviate those specified for the entire device. For the entire device where
this accessory is installed, refer to the data provided specifically for the entire
device.
1) Speed specification with 1X = 150 KB/s. All specifications refer to the Samsung Flash chips, CompactFlash cards in UDMA mode 4, 30
ns cycle time in True-IDE mode with sequential write/read test.
2) The file is written/read sequentially in True IDE mode with the DOS program Thruput.exe.
3) Endurance of B&R CF cards (linear written block size with 128 kB)
4) Depending on the average file size.
5) Not supported by B&R Embedded OS installer.
Accessories
Chapter 6
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Storage
50 Operation
Transport
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150
- Temperature [°C] +
5.4 Dimensions
1.60 ±0.05
0.99 ±0.05
26 50
1 25
1.01 ±0.07 1.01 ±0.07
3.30 ±0.1
2x 12 ±0.10
2x 3 ±0.07
CompactFlash type I
2x 25.78 ±0.07
2.44 ±0.07
36.4 ±0.15
Top
0.76 ±0.7
5.5 Benchmark
40
35
30
25
Transfer rate [MB/s]
20
15
10
40
35
30
25
Transfer rate [MB/s]
20
15
10
5
Accessories
Chapter 6
Information:
On Windows CE 5.0 devices, 5CFCRD.xxxx-03 CompactFlash cards up to 1GB are
supported.
Caution!
A sudden loss of power can cause data to be lost! In very rare cases, the mass
memory may also become damaged.
To prevent damage and loss of data, B&R recommends that you use a UPS device.
Information:
The following characteristics, features and limit values only apply to this accessory
and can deviate those specified for the entire device. For the entire device where
this accessory is installed, refer to the data provided specifically for the entire
device.
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55 Storage
50 Operation
Transport
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
- Temperature [°C] +
6.4 Dimensions
1.60 ±0.05
0.99 ±0.05
26 50
1 25
1.01 ±0.07 1.01 ±0.07
3.30 ±0.1
2x 12 ±0.10
2x 3 ±0.07
CompactFlash type I
2x 25.78 ±0.07
2.44 ±0.07
36.4 ±0.15
Top
0.76 ±0.7
1.65 0.63 ±0.07
41.66 ±0.13
4 x R0.5 ±0.1
42.8 ±0.1
Accessories
Chapter 6
Information:
We reserve the right to supply alternative products due to the vast quantity of flash
drives available on the market and their corresponding short product lifecycle. As a
result, the following measures may be necessary (e.g. Therefore, the following
measures might be necessary in order to boot from these flash drives (e.g. the
SanDisk Cruzer Micro flash drive with 2 GB):
• The flash drive must be reformatted or in some cases even re-partitioned (set
active partition).
• The flash drive must be at the top of the BIOS boot order, or alternatively the
IDE controllers can also be deactivated in the BIOS. This can be avoided in
most cases if a "fdisk /mbr" command is also executed on the USB flash
drive.
USB flash drives are easy-to-exchange storage media. Because of the fast data transfer (USB
2.0), the USB flash drives are ideal for use as a portable memory medium. Without requiring
additional drivers ("Hot Plug & Play" - except with Windows 98SE), the USB flash drive can be
converted immediately into an additional drive where data can be read or written. Only USB flash
drives from the memory specialists SanDisk are used.
Information:
The following characteristics, features and limit values only apply to this accessory
and can deviate those specified for the entire device. For the entire device where
this accessory is installed, refer to the data provided specifically for the entire
device.
The technical data is current as of when this manual was printed. We reserve the
right to make changes.
Features 5MMUSB.2048-00
LED 1 LED (green), signals data transfer (send and receive)
Power supply Via the USB port
Current requirements 650 µA sleep mode, 150 mA read/write
Interface USB specification 2.0 high speed device, mass storage class, USB-IF and WHQL certified
Type USB 1.1 and 2.0 compatible
Transfer rate Up to 480 MBit (high speed)
Sequential reading Max. 8.7 MB/second
Sequential writing Max. 1.7 MB/second
Connection To each USB type A interface
MTBF (at +25°C) 100,000 hours
Data retention 10 years
Maintenance None
Operating system support Windows CE 5.0 and Windows XP embedded
Mechanical characteristics
Dimensions
Length 52.2 mm
Width 19 mm
Thickness 7.9 mm
Environmental characteristics
Ambient temperature
Operation 0 to +45°C
Bearings -20 to +60°C
Transport -20 to +60°C
Relative humidity
Operation 10 to 90%, non-condensing
Bearings 5 to 90%, non-condensing
Transport 5 to 90%, non-condensing
Vibration
Operation 2 g (10 to 500 Hz), oscillation rate 1/minute
Bearings 4 g (10 to 500 Hz), oscillation rate 1/minute
Transport 4 g (10 to 500 Hz), oscillation rate 1/minute
Accessories
Chapter 6
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
Transport
Storage
50 Operation
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
9 5 9 5
6 6
1 1
Pin assignments
DSUB (9-pin), female DSUB (9-pin), female
8 7
7 8
5 5
2 3
3 2
4 1
6 6
1 4
Shield Shield
Figure 338: Pin assignments - null modem cable
Maintenance / Servicing
Chapter 7
Chapter 7 • Maintenance / Servicing
1. Cleaning
Danger!
Power Panel devices may only be cleaned when switched off. This is to prevent
unintended functions from being triggered when touching the touch screen or
pressing the buttons.
A moist towel should be used to clean the Power Panel device. When moistening the cloth, use
only water with detergent, screen cleaning agent, or alcohol (ethanol). The cleaning agent
should be applied to the cloth beforehand, not sprayed directly on the Power Panel device! Never
use aggressive solvents, chemicals, scouring agents, pressurized air or steam jet.
Information:
Displays with touch screens should be cleaned at regular intervals.
The battery guarantees buffering of the internal real-time clock (RTC), SRAM data, and
individually saved BIOS settings. For more information about the batteries for each device, see
chapter 2 "Technical data" on page 39.
Changing the battery is only necessary for devices with a lithium battery (see section "Technical
data" on page 39 for Power Panel devices).
Battery check
The battery status (good or bad) is checked every time the device is turned on, as well as every
24 hours. The check involves applying a load to the battery for a short time (approx. 1 second),
followed by an evaluation. The evaluated battery status is displayed in the BIOS Setup pages
and in the B&R Control Center (ADI driver), but can also be read in a customer application via
the ADI Library.
From the point when battery capacity is recognized as insufficient, data buffering is guaranteed
for approximately another 500 hours.
Information:
The battery should only be changed by qualified personnel.
Technical data
Maintenance / Servicing
0 aPCI slot Power Panel devices 1 or 2 aPCI slot Power Panel devices
Chapter 7
Table 244: Changing the battery
• Carefully remove the used battery from the holder by pulling the removal strip.
• Do not touch the new battery with pliers or uninsulated tweezers ->risk of short circuiting.
The battery should not be held by its edges.
Correct Incorrect
• Insert the new battery with correct polarity. The correct positioning of the removal strip
must be taken into consideration.
• Put on the battery cover and fasten the screws.
• Reconnect the power supply to the Power Panel.
• The data and time in BIOS may have to be set again (see section "Power Panel 300 with
BIOS" on page 397).
Warning!
Lithium batteries are considered hazardous waste. Used batteries should be
disposed of accordingly.
Burn-in effect (after images, display memory effect, image retention or also image sticking)
occurs in LCD/TFT monitors when a static image is displayed for a long period of time. This static
screen content causes the build-up of parasitic capacities within the LCD components that
prevent the liquid crystal molecules from returning to their original states. This condition may
arise, is not predictable and depends on the following factors:
There is no total solution, however, measures can be taken to significantly reduce this effect:
Appendix A
1. Touch screen
Appendix A
1.1 Elo Accu Touch
Information:
The following characteristics, features, and limit values only apply to this individual
component and can deviate from those specified for the entire device. For the entire
device in which this individual component is used, refer to the data given
specifically for the entire device.
1) The active area of the touch screen is resistant to these chemicals for a timeframe of one hour at +21°C.
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
55
50 Storage
Operation
45 Transport
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
1.1.2 Cleaning
The touch screen should be cleaned with a moist lint-free cloth. When moistening the cloth, use
only water with detergent, screen cleaning agent, or alcohol (ethanol). The cleaning agent
should be applied to the cloth beforehand and not sprayed directly onto the touch screen itself.
Never use aggressive solvents, chemicals, scouring agents, pressurized air or steam jet.
Information:
The following characteristics, features, and limit values only apply to this individual
component and can deviate from those specified for the entire device. For the entire
device in which this individual component is used, refer to the data given
specifically for the entire device.
Appendix A
Elo Accu touch screen Specifications
Manufacturer Gunze
Release pressure 10 to 80 g
Light permeability 79%
Temperature
Operation 0 to +50°C
Bearings -20 to +70°C
Transport -20 to +70°C
Relative humidity See 1.2.1 "Temperature humidity diagram" on page 534
Lifespan 1 million touch operations
Chemical resistance 1) Acetone, ammonia-based glass cleaner, normal food and drinks,
hexane, methylene chloride, methyl ethyl ketone, mineral spirits, turpentine, isopropyl alcohol
Activation Finger, pencil
1) The active area of the touch screen is resistant to these chemicals for a timeframe of one hour at +21°C.
100
95
90
85
Relative humidity [%RH] (non-condensing)
80
75
70
65
60
Transport
55
Storage
50 Operation
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
-80 -70 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
- Temperature [°C] +
1.2.2 Cleaning
The touch screen should be cleaned with a moist lint-free cloth. When moistening the cloth, use
only water with detergent, screen cleaning agent, or alcohol (ethanol). The cleaning agent
should be applied to the cloth beforehand and not sprayed directly onto the touch screen itself.
Never use aggressive solvents, chemicals, scouring agents, pressurized air or steam jet.
2. Décor foil
The décor foil conforms to DIN 42115 (section 2). This means it is resistant to exposure to the
following chemicals for a 24-hour period with no visible signs of damage:
Information:
The following characteristics, features, and limit values only apply to this individual
component and can deviate from those specified for the entire device.
Appendix A
Ethanol Formaldehyde 37%-42% 1.1.1.Trichloroethane
Cyclohexanol Acetaldehyde Ethyl acetate
Diacetone alcohol Aliphatic hydrocarbons Diethyl ether
Glycol Toluene N-Butyl acetate
Isopropanol Xylene Amyl acetate
Glycerine White spirits Butylcellosolve
Methanol Ether
Triacetin
Dowandol
DRM/PM
Acetone Formic acid <50% Sodium hypochlorite <20%
Methyl ethyl ketone Acetic acid <50% Hydrogen peroxide <25%
Dioxan Phosphoric acid <30% Potassium carbonate
Cyclohexanone Hydrochloric acid <36% Washing agents
MIBK Nitric acid <10% Fabric conditioner
Isophorone Trichloracetic acid <50% Ferric chloride
Sulphuric acid <10% Ferrous chloride (FeCl2)
Ferrous chloride (FeCl3)
Ammonia <40% Cutting oil Dibutyl phthalate
Caustic soda <40% Diesel oil Dioctyl phthalate
Potassium hydroxide Linseed oil Sodium carbonate
Alkali carbonate Paraffin oil
Bichromate Blown castor oil
Potassium Silicon oil
Acetonitrile Turpentine oil substitute
Sodium bisulphate Universal brake fluid
Aviation fuel
Gasoline
Water
Sea water
Decon
The décor foil conforms to DIN 42115 section 2 for exposure to glacial acetic acid for less than
one hour without visible damage.
3. Viewing angles
The perspective information (R,L,U,D) can be seen in the technical data for the individual
components.
L U
D R
6 o’clock direction
4. Mounting compatibilities
This section describes the compatibility of the installation dimensions for the Power Panel
100/200, Power Panel 300/400, Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 units according to the
respective device diagonals.
The outer dimensions of the device types are identical for the respective diagonals.
The different device types are abbreviated as follows:
Appendix A
Power Panel 100/200 PP100/200
Power Panel 300/400 PP300/400
Automation Panel 900 AP900
Panel PC 700 PPC700
The following table offers a brief overview of the devices PP100/200, PP300/400, AP900 and
PPC700. Detailed information can be found in the section "Compatibility details" on page 539.
Compatibility between the device types is represented on each line by matching symbols.
dimensions
Installation ● ● - -
dimensions
Outer ■ ■ - -
Horizontal2
dimensions
Installation ● ● - -
5.7“ dimensions
Outer ■ ■ - -
dimensions
Vertical1
Installation ● ● - -
dimensions
Installation ● ● ● ●
dimensions
Outer ■ ■ ■ ■
Horizontal2
dimensions
Installation ● ● ▲ ▲
10.4“
dimensions
Outer ■ ■ ■ ■
dimensions
Vertical1
Installation ● ● ▲ ▲
dimensions
Outer ■ ■ ■ ■
Horizontal1
dimensions
12.1“ Installation ● ● ▲ ▲
dimensions
Outer ■ ■ ■ ■
Horizontal1
dimensions
Installation ● ● ● ●
dimensions
15“ Outer ■ ■ ■ ■
dimensions
Vertical1
Installation ● ● ● ●
dimensions
The measurement values (all in mm) in the following figures have the following meaning.
Appendix A
Installation dimensions
e.g. depends on device type
402 x 266.5 ± 0.5
PP100/200/300/400 402 x 271 ± 0.5 AP900/PPC700
Specification of
difference
4.5
13 PP100/200/300/400
8.5 AP900, PPC700
Outer contour of device
Space to edge of device on top
PP100/200/200/300/400 device cutout
e.g. depends on device type
AP900/PPC700 device cutout
PP100/200/300/400
6.5
Outer counter of device
Cutout for device
5.7" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 devices in Horizontal1 format are 100%
mounting compatible.
PP100/200/300/400
6.5
5.7" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 devices in Vertical1 format are 100%
mounting compatible.
PP100/200/300/400
11.7
5.7" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 devices in Vertical1 format are 100%
mounting compatible.
10 323 x 260 10
8.5
PP100/200/300/400 AP900/PPC700
303 x 243 ± 0.5
Appendix A
PP100/200/300/400 AP900
8.5
10.4" Power Panel 100/200, Power Panel 300/400, Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700
devices in Horizontal1 format are 100% mounting compatible.
10 423 x 288 10
8.5
13 PP100/200/300/400
8.5 AP900, PPC700
Outer contour of device
PP100/200/200/300/400 device cutout
AP900/PPC700 device cutout
10.4" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 are are not 100% mounting compatible
with the Horizontal2 format Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 devices. The Automation
Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 devices require a cutout that is 4.5 mm larger vertically (lower
edge).
The larger cutout can can be conditionally used for all devices:
• When mounting, make sure that the PP100/200/300/400 devices are placed and
mounted as close to the center of the cutout as possible. Failure to do so can prevent the
retaining clips from holding firmly, which means that a firm seal is no longer guaranteed
with the gasket (IP65).
10 323 x 358 10
8.5
13.5 PP100/200/300/400
8.5 AP900, PPC700
10.4" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 are not 100% mounting compatible with
the Vertical1 format for the Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 devices. The Automation
Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 devices require a cutout that is 5 mm larger vertically (lower edge).
The larger cutout can can be conditionally used for all devices:
• When mounting, make sure that the PP100/200/300/400 devices are placed and
mounted as close to the center of the cutout as possible. Failure to do so can prevent the
retaining clips from holding firmly, which means that a firm seal is no longer guaranteed
with the gasket (IP65).
Appendix A
342 x 267 ± 0.5
PP100/200/300/400 AP900/PPC700
8.5
1.5 1.5
12.1" Power Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 are not 100% mounting compatible with
the Horizontal1 format for the Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700 devices. The Power
Panel 100/200 and Power Panel 300/400 devices require a cut that is 1.5 mm wider (left and
right).
The larger cutout can can be conditionally used for all devices:
• When mounting, make sure that the AP900 and PPC700 devices can be placed and
mounted as close to the center of the cutout as possible.
10 435 x 330 10
9
PP100/200/300/400 AP900/PPC700
415 x 312 ± 0.5
PP100/200/300/400 AP900
9
15" Power Panel 100/200, Power Panel 300/400, Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700
devices in Horizontal1 format are 100% mounting compatible.
10 435 x 430 10
9
9
Outer contour of device
Device cutout
15" Power Panel 100/200, Power Panel 300/400, Automation Panel 900 and Panel PC 700
devices in Vertical1 format are 100% mounting compatible.
On display units, it is often necessary to adjust the function keys and LEDs for the application
software being used. With the B&R Key Editor, it is possible to quickly and easily set up the
application individually.
Appendix A
Features:
• Automation PC 820
• Automation PC 800
• Automation PC 620 (ETX, XTX, Embedded)
• Power Panel 300/400
• Power Panel 100.200
• Power Panel 65
• Panel PC 300
• Panel PC 700 (ETX, XTX)
• Panel PC 800
• Mobile Panel 40/50
• Mobile Panel 100, 200
• IPC2000, IPC2001, IPC2002
• IPC5000, IPC5600
• IPC5000C, IPC5600C
A detailed guide for configuring keys and LEDs can be found in the B&R Key Editor's online help.
The B&R Key Editor can be downloaded for free from the download area on the B&R homepage
(www.br-automation.com). Additionally, it can also be found on the B&R HMI Drivers & Utilities
DVD (model number 5SWHMI.0000-00).
The ADI Development Kit can be used to activate functions in the B&R Automation Device
Interface (ADI) from Windows applications, which were created using Microsoft Visual C++ or
Microsoft Visual Basic 6.0.
Appendix A
Figure 354: ADI development kit screenshots (Version 2.40)
Features:
• Automation PC 620
• Automation PC 810
• Automation PC 820
• Mobile Panel 40/50
• Mobile Panel 100/200
• Panel PC 300
• Panel PC 700
• Panel PC 800
• Power Panel 100/200
• Power Panel 300/400
A detailed description of using the ADI functions can be found in the integrated online help.
The B&R Automation Device Interface (ADI) development kit can be downloaded for free from
the download area on the B&R homepage (www.br-automation.com).
7. Glossary
ACPI
Abbreviation for "Advanced Configuration and Power Interface". Configuration interface that
enables the operating system to control the power supply for each device connected to the PC.
With ACPI, the computer's BIOS is only responsible for the details of communication with the
hardware.
Appendix A
Automation Runtime
A uniform runtime system for all B&R automation components.
BIOS
An abbreviation for "Basic Input/Output System". Core software for computer systems with
essential routines for controlling input and output processes on hardware components, for
performing tests after system start, and for loading the operating system. Although BIOS is used
to configure a system's performance, the user does not usually come into contact with it.
-bit
Binary digit > binary position, binary character, smallest discrete unit of information. A bit can
have the value 0 or 1.
Bit rate
The number of bits that can be transferred within a specified time unit. 1 bit/sec = 1 baud.
Bootstrap loader
A program that automatically runs when the computer is switched on or restarted. After some
basic hardware tests have been carried out, the bootstrap loader starts a larger loader and hands
over control to it, which in turn boots the operating system. The bootstrap loader is typically found
in ROM on the computer.
Byte
Data format [1 byte = 8 bits] and a unit for characterizing information amounts and memory
capacity. The following units are the commonly used units of progression: KB, MB, GB.
Windows-based program for creating installation disks to install B&R Automation Runtime™ on
the target system.
Cache
Background memory, also known as non-addressable memory or fast buffer memory. It is used
to relieve the fast main memory of a computer. For example, data that should be output to slower
components by the working memory (e.g. disk storage, printers) is stored temporarily in cache
memory and output from there at an appropriate speed for the target devices.
CE mark
A CE mark for a product. It consists of the letters "CE" and indicates conformity to all EU
guidelines for the labeled product. It indicates that the individual or corporate body who has
performed or attached the label assures that the product conforms to all EU guidelines for
complete harmonization. It also indicates that all mandatory conformity evaluation procedures
have taken place.
CMOS
"CMOS" is a battery powered memory area where fundamental parameters of an IBM (or
compatible) personal computer are stored. Information such as the type of hard drive, size of the
working memory and the current date and time are required when booting the computer. As the
name suggests, the memory is based on CMOS technology standards.
COM
A device name used to access serial ports in MS-DOS. The first serial port can be accessed
under COM1, the second under COM2, etc. A modem, mouse, or serial printer is typically
connected to a serial port.
CompactFlash®
CompactFlash memory cards [CF cards] are exchangeable nonvolatile mass memory systems
with very small dimensions [43 x 36 x 3.3 mm, approximately half the size of a credit card]. In
addition to the flash memory chips, the controller is also present on the cards. CF cards provide
complete PC card / ATA functionality and compatibility. A 50-pin CF card can be simply inserted
in a passive 68-pin type II adapter card. It conforms to all electrical and mechanical PC card
interface specifications. CF cards were launched by SanDisk back in 1994. Currently, memory
capacities reach up to 8 GB per unit. Since 1995, CompactFlash Association [CFA] has been
looking after standardization and the worldwide distribution of CF technology
Controller
A device component which allows access to other devices on a computer subsystem. A disk
controller, for example, allows access to hard disks and disk drives and is responsible both for
physical and logic drive access.
CPU
An abbreviation for "Central Processing Unit". Interprets and executes commands. It is also
known as a "microprocessor" or "processor" for short. A processor is able to receive, decode and
execute commands, as well as transfer information to and from other resources via the computer
bus.
CTS
An abbreviation for "Clear To Send". A signal used when transferring serial data from modem to
computer, indicating its readiness to send the data. CTS is a hardware signal which is transferred
Appendix A
via line number 5 in compliance with the RS-232-C standard.
DCD
An abbreviation for " Data Carrier Detected". A signal used in serial communication that is sent
by the modem to the computer it is connected to, indicating that it is ready for transfer.
DDR SDRAM
Abbreviation for "Double Data Rate Synchronous Dynamic Random Access Memory".
DMA
Direct Memory Access >. Accelerated direct access to a computer’s RAM by bypassing the
CPU.
DRAM
DSR
An abbreviation for "Data Set Ready". A signal used in serial data transfer that is sent by the
modem to the computer it is connected to, indicating its readiness for processing. DSR is a
hardware signal which is sent via line number 6 in compliance with the RS-232-C standard.
DTR
An abbreviation for "Data Terminal Ready". A signal used in serial data transfer that is sent by
the computer to the modem it is connected to, indicating the computer's readiness to accept
incoming signals.
EDID data
Abbreviation for "Extended Display Identification Data". EDID data contains the characteristics
of monitors / TFT displays transferred as 128 KB data blocks to the graphics card via the Display
Data Channel (DDC). This EDID data can be used to set the graphics card to the monitor
properties.
EMC
Encode, encoding
When processing information, it is often necessary to change the information from one form of
representation to another. This conversion process is called encoding, and the rules used to
assign one character set to another are referred to as encoding rules. A differentiation is made
between ambiguous and unambiguous encoding depending on if one set is a direct reflection of
the other. Most codes use unambiguous encoding with one set directly reflecting the other. A
differentiation is also made between redundant and non-redundant encoding. With non-
redundant encoding, the full range of the available character set is used, i.e. each code is
defined. With redundant encoding, the available character set also contains codes that are not
used. This differentiation is important during data transfer when detecting and, if necessary,
correcting data transfer errors.
EPROM
Ethernet
An IEEE 802.3 standard for networks. Ethernet uses bus or star topology and controls the traffic
on communication lines using the access procedure CSMA/CD (Carrier Sense Multiple Access
with Collision Detection). Network nodes are connected using coaxial cables, fiber optic cables
or twisted pair cabling. Data transfer on an Ethernet network takes place in frames of variable
lengths that consist of supply and controller information as well as 1500 bytes of data. The
Ethernet standard provides base band transfers at 10 megabit and 100 megabit per second.
FIFO
An abbreviation for "First In First Out". A queuing organization method whereby elements are
removed in the same order as they were inserted. The first element inserted is the first one
removed. Such an organization method is typical for a list of documents that are waiting to be
printed.
Firmware
Appendix A
GB
Handshake
Method of synchronization for data transfer when data is sent at irregular intervals. The sender
signals that data can be sent, and the receiver signals when new data can be received.
IDE
An abbreviation for "Integrated Drive Electronics". A drive interface where the controller
electronics are integrated in the drive.
Interface
From the hardware point of view, an interface is the connection point between two
modules/devices/systems. The units on both sides of the interface are connected by the
interface lines so that data, addresses, and control signals can be exchanged. The term interface
includes all functional, electrical and constructive conditions [encoding, signal level, pin
assignments] that characterize the connection point between the modules, devices, or systems.
Depending on the type of data transfer, a differentiation is made between parallel [e.g.
Centronics, IEEE 488] and serial interfaces [e.g. V.24, TTY, RS232, RS422, RS485], which are
set up for different transfer speeds and transfer distances. From the point of view of software,
the term "interface" describes the transfer point between program modules using specified rules
for transferring the program data.
ISO
LCD
An abbreviation for "Liquid Crystal Display". A display type, based on liquid crystals that have a
polarized molecular structure and are enclosed between two transparent electrodes as a thin
layer. If an electrical field is applied to the electrodes, the molecules align themselves with the
field and form crystalline arrangements that polarize the light passing through. A polarization
filter, which is arranged using lamellar electrodes, blocks the polarized light. In this way, a cell
(pixel) containing liquid crystals can be switched on using electrode gates, thus coloring this pixel
black. Some LCD displays have an electroluminescent plate behind the LCD screen for lighting.
Other types of LCD displays can use color.
LED
An abbreviation for "Light Emitting Diode". A semiconductor diode which converts electrical
energy into light. LEDs work on the principle of electroluminescence. They are highly efficient
because they do not produce much heat in spite of the amount of light they emit. For example,
"operational status indicators" on floppy disk drives are LEDs.
MB
Microprocessor
Highly integrated circuit with the functionality of a CPU, normally housed on a single chip. It
comprises a control unit, arithmetic and logic unit, several registers and a link system for
connecting memory and peripheral components. The main performance features are the internal
and external data bus and address bus widths, the command set and the clock frequency.
Additionally, a choice can be made between CISC and RISC processors. The first commercially
available worldwide microprocessor was the Intel 4004. It came on the market in 1971.
MTBF
An abbreviation for "Mean time between failure". The average time which passes before a
hardware component fails and repair is needed. This time is usually expressed in thousands or
ten thousands of hours, sometimes known as power-on hours (POH).
Multitasking
Multitasking is an operating mode in an operating system that allows several computer tasks to
be executed virtually simultaneously.
Node
PnP
An abbreviation for "Plug and Play". Specifications developed by Intel. Using Plug and Play
allows a PC to automatically configure itself so that it can communicate with peripheral devices
(e.g. monitors, modems, and printers). Users can connect a peripheral device (plug) and it
immediately runs (play) without having to manually configure the system. A Plug and Play PC
requires a BIOS that supports Plug and Play and a respective expansion card.
POH
Appendix A
An abbreviation for "Power On Hours". See MTBF.
POST
An abbreviation for "Power-On Self Test". A set of routines that are stored in ROM on the
computer and that test different system components, e.g. RAM, disk drive and the keyboard in
order to determine that the connection is operating correctly and ready for operation. POST
routines notify the user of problems that occur. This is done using several signal tones or by
displaying a message that frequently accompanies a diagnosis value on the standard output or
standard error devices (generally the monitor). If the POST runs successfully, control is
transferred over to the system's bootstrap loader.
Power Panel
Power Panel is part of the B&R product family and is a combination of an operator panel and
controller in one device. This covers the PP21 and PP41 products.
QVGA
Abbreviation for Quarter Video Graphics Array. Usually a screen resolution of 320 × 240 pixels.
RAM
An abbreviation for "Random Access Memory". Semiconductor memory which can be read or
written to by the microprocessor or other hardware components. Memory locations can be
accessed in any order. The various ROM memory types do allow random access, but they
cannot be written to. The term RAM refers to a more temporary memory that can be written to
as well as read.
ROM
An abbreviation for "Read-Only Memory". Semiconductor memory where programs or data were
permanently stored during the production process.
RS232
Recommended Standard Number 232. Oldest and most widespread interface standard, also
called a V.24 interface. All signals are referenced to ground making this an unbalanced interface.
High level: -3 to -30 V, low level: +3 to +30 V; cable lengths up to 15 m, transfer rates up to 20
kbit/s; for point-to-point connections between 2 stations.
RTS
An abbreviation for "Request To Send". A signal used in serial data transfer for requesting send
permission. For example, it is sent from a computer to the modem connected to it. The RTS
signal is assigned to pin 4 according to the hardware specifications of the RS-232-C standard.
RXD
An abbreviation for "Receive (RX) Data". A line for transferring serial data received from one
device to another, e.g. from a modem to a computer. For connections complying with the RS-
232-C standard, the RXD is connected to pin 3 of the plug.
SDRAM
SRAM
An abbreviation for "Static Random Access Memory". A semiconductor memory (RAM) made up
of certain logic circuits (flip-flop) that only keeps stored information while powered. In computers,
static RAM is generally only used for cache memory.
SVGA
Abbreviation for »Super Video Graphics Array«; Graphics standard with a resolution of at least
800×600 pixels and at least 256 colors.
TCP/IP
Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Suit of Protocols. Network protocol that has become the
generally accepted standard for data exchange in heterogeneous networks. TCP/IP is used both
in local networks for communication between various computer and also for LAN to WAN
access.
TFT display
LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) technology where the display consists of a large grid of LCD cells.
Each pixel is represented by a cell, whereby electrical fields produced in the cells are supported
by thin film transistors (TFT) that result in an active matrix. In its simplest form, there is exactly
one thin film transistor per cell. Displays with an active matrix are generally used in laptops and
notebooks because they are thin, offer high-quality color displays and can be viewed from all
angles.
Touch screen
Appendix A
Screen with touch sensors for activating an item with the finger.
TXD
An abbreviation for "Transmit (TX) Data". A line for the transfer of serial data sent from one
device to another, e.g. from a computer to a modem. For connections complying with the RS-
232-C standard, the TXD is connected to pin 2 of the plug.
UART
UDMA
An abbreviation for "Ultra Direct Memory Access". A special IDE data transfer mode that allows
high data transfer rates for drives. There have been many variations in recent times.
UDMA33 mode transfers 33 megabytes per second.
UDMA66 mode transfers 66 megabytes per second.
UDMA100 mode transfers 100 megabytes per second.
Both the mainboard and the hard drive must support the specification to implement
modifications.
USB
An abbreviation for »Universal Serial Bus« A serial bus with a bandwidth of up to 12 megabits
per second (Mbit/s) for connecting a peripheral device to a microcomputer. Up to 127 devices
can be connected to the system using a single multipurpose connection, the USB bus (e.g.
external CD drives, printers, modems as well as the mouse and keyboard). This is done by
connecting the devices in a row. USB allows devices to be changed when the power supply is
switched on (hot plugging) and multi-layered data flow.
VGA
An abbreviation for "Video Graphics Adapter". A video adapter which can handle all EGA
(Enhanced Graphics Adapter) video modes and adds several new modes.
Visual Components
Integrated in B&R Automation Studio. Visual Components can be used to configure visualization
projects that use text and graphics.
Windows CE
Compact 32-bit operating system with multitasking and multithreading that Microsoft developed
especially for the OEM market. It can be ported for various processor types and has a high
degree of real-time capability. The development environment uses proven, well-established
development tools. It is an open and scalable Windows operating system platform for many
different devices. Examples of such devices are handheld PCs, digital wireless receivers,
intelligent mobile phones, multimedia consoles, etc. In embedded systems, Windows CE is also
an excellent choice for automation technology.
XGA
An abbreviation for "EXtended Graphics Array". An expanded standard for graphics controllers
and monitors that was introduced by IBM in 1990. This standard supports 640x480 resolution
with 65,536 colors or 1024x768 resolution with 256 colors. This standard is generally used in
workstation systems.
Figure index
Figure 1: Power Panel 300 and Power Panel 400 devices ........................................... 39
Figure 2: Different plug and key positions (PP100/200 - PP300/400) ........................... 41
Figure 3: Supply voltage connection ............................................................................. 42
Figure 4: Functional grounding clip ............................................................................... 43
Figure 5: BIOS boot mode switch.................................................................................. 47
Figure 6: CompactFlash slot.......................................................................................... 51
Figure 7: Device label.................................................................................................... 52
Figure 8: Design / dimensions - Serial number sticker .................................................. 52
Figure 9: Example - Material number search: 5PP320.0571-29 ................................... 53
Figure 10: Front view - 5PP320.0571-29......................................................................... 54
Figure index
Figure 11: Rear view - 5PP320.0571-29 ......................................................................... 54
Figure 12: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.0571-29 ........................................ 58
Figure 13: Dimensions - 5PP320.0571-29 ...................................................................... 58
Figure 14: Cutout installation - 5PP320.0571-29............................................................. 59
Figure 15: Front view - 5PP320.0571-39......................................................................... 60
Figure 16: Rear view - 5PP320.0571-39 ......................................................................... 60
Figure 17: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.0571-39 ........................................ 64
Figure 18: Dimensions - 5PP320.0571-39 ...................................................................... 64
Figure 19: Cutout installation - 5PP320.0571-39............................................................. 65
Figure 20: Front view - 5PP320.0573-39......................................................................... 66
Figure 21: Rear view - 5PP320.0573-39 ......................................................................... 66
Figure 22: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.0573-39 ........................................ 70
Figure 23: Dimensions - 5PP320.0573-39 ...................................................................... 70
Figure 24: Cutout installation - 5PP320.0573-39............................................................. 71
Figure 25: Front view - 5PP320.0573-3B ........................................................................ 72
Figure 26: Rear view - 5PP320.0573-3B......................................................................... 72
Figure 27: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.0573-3B........................................ 76
Figure 28: Dimensions - 5PP320.0573-3B ...................................................................... 76
Figure 29: Cutout installation - 5PP320.0573-3B ............................................................ 77
Figure 30: Front view - 5PP320.1043-39......................................................................... 78
Figure 31: Rear view - 5PP320.1043-39 ......................................................................... 78
Figure 32: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.1043-39 ........................................ 82
Figure 33: Dimensions - 5PP320.1043-39 ...................................................................... 82
Figure 34: Cutout installation - 5PP320.1043-39............................................................. 83
Figure 35: Front view - 5PP320.1214-39......................................................................... 84
Figure 36: Rear view - 5PP320.1214-39 ......................................................................... 84
Figure 37: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.1214-39 ........................................ 88
Figure 38: Dimensions - 5PP320.1214-39 ...................................................................... 88
Figure 39: Cutout installation - 5PP320.1214-39............................................................. 89
Figure 40: Front view - 5PP320.1505-39......................................................................... 90
Figure 41: Rear view - 5PP320.1505-39 ......................................................................... 90
Figure 42: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.1505-39 ........................................ 94
Figure 43: Dimensions - 5PP320.1505-39 ...................................................................... 94
Figure 44: Cutout installation - 5PP320.1505-39............................................................. 95
Figure 45: Front view - 5PP320.1505-3B ........................................................................ 96
Figure 46: Rear view - 5PP320.1505-3B......................................................................... 96
Figure 47: Temperature humidity diagram - 5PP320.1505-3B...................................... 100
Figure index
Figure 105: Front view - 4PP420.0571-45....................................................................... 175
Figure 106: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-45 ....................................................................... 175
Figure 107: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-45 ...................................... 179
Figure 108: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-45 .................................................................... 179
Figure 109: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-45........................................................... 180
Figure 110: Front view - 4PP420.0571-65....................................................................... 181
Figure 111: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-65 ....................................................................... 181
Figure 112: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-65 ...................................... 185
Figure 113: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-65 .................................................................... 185
Figure 114: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-65........................................................... 186
Figure 115: Front view - 4PP420.0571-75....................................................................... 187
Figure 116: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-75 ....................................................................... 187
Figure 117: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-75 ...................................... 191
Figure 118: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-75 .................................................................... 191
Figure 119: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-75........................................................... 192
Figure 120: Front view - 4PP420.0571-85....................................................................... 193
Figure 121: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-85 ....................................................................... 193
Figure 122: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-85 ...................................... 197
Figure 123: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-85 .................................................................... 197
Figure 124: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-85........................................................... 198
Figure 125: Front view - 4PP420.0571-A5 ...................................................................... 199
Figure 126: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-A5....................................................................... 199
Figure 127: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-A5...................................... 203
Figure 128: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-A5 .................................................................... 203
Figure 129: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-A5 .......................................................... 204
Figure 130: Front view - 4PP420.0571-B5 ...................................................................... 205
Figure 131: Rear view - 4PP420.0571-B5....................................................................... 205
Figure 132: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0571-B5...................................... 209
Figure 133: Dimensions - 4PP420.0571-B5 .................................................................... 209
Figure 134: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0571-B5 .......................................................... 210
Figure 135: Front view - 4PP420.0573-75....................................................................... 211
Figure 136: Rear view - 4PP420.0573-75 ....................................................................... 211
Figure 137: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP420.0573-75 ...................................... 215
Figure 138: Dimensions - 4PP420.0573-75 .................................................................... 215
Figure 139: Cutout installation - 4PP420.0573-75........................................................... 216
Figure 140: Front view - 4PP420.1043-75....................................................................... 217
Figure 141: Rear view - 4PP420.1043-75 ....................................................................... 217
Figure index
Figure 199: Cutout installation - 4PP452.0571-45........................................................... 290
Figure 200: Front view - 4PP452.0571-65....................................................................... 291
Figure 201: Rear view - 4PP452.0571-65 ....................................................................... 291
Figure 202: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP452.0571-65 ...................................... 295
Figure 203: Dimensions - 4PP452.0571-65 .................................................................... 295
Figure 204: Cutout installation - 4PP452.0571-65........................................................... 296
Figure 205: Front view - 4PP452.0571-75....................................................................... 297
Figure 206: Rear view - 4PP452.0571-75 ....................................................................... 297
Figure 207: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP452.0571-75 ...................................... 301
Figure 208: Dimensions - 4PP452.0571-75 .................................................................... 302
Figure 209: Cutout installation - 4PP452.0571-75........................................................... 303
Figure 210: Front view - 4PP452.0571-B5 ...................................................................... 304
Figure 211: Rear view - 4PP452.0571-B5....................................................................... 304
Figure 212: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP452.0571-B5...................................... 308
Figure 213: Dimensions - 4PP452.0571-B5 .................................................................... 309
Figure 214: Cutout installation - 4PP452.0571-B5 .......................................................... 310
Figure 215: Front view - 4PP452.1043-75....................................................................... 311
Figure 216: Rear view - 4PP452.1043-75 ....................................................................... 311
Figure 217: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP452.1043-75 ...................................... 315
Figure 218: Dimensions - 4PP452.1043-75 .................................................................... 315
Figure 219: Cutout installation - 4PP452.1043-75........................................................... 316
Figure 220: Front view - 4PP480.1043-75....................................................................... 317
Figure 221: Rear view - 4PP480.1043-75 ....................................................................... 317
Figure 222: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP480.1043-75 ...................................... 321
Figure 223: Dimensions - 4PP480.1043-75 .................................................................... 321
Figure 224: Cutout installation - 4PP480.1043-75........................................................... 322
Figure 225: Front view - 4PP480.1505-75....................................................................... 323
Figure 226: Rear view - 4PP480.1505-75 ....................................................................... 323
Figure 227: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP480.1505-75 ...................................... 327
Figure 228: Dimensions - 4PP480.1505-75 .................................................................... 327
Figure 229: Cutout installation - 4PP480.1505-75........................................................... 328
Figure 230: Front view - 4PP480.1505-B5 ...................................................................... 329
Figure 231: Rear view - 4PP480.1505-B5....................................................................... 329
Figure 232: Temperature humidity diagram - 4PP480.1505-B5...................................... 333
Figure 233: Dimensions - 4PP480.1505-B5 .................................................................... 333
Figure 234: Cutout installation - 4PP480.1505-B5 .......................................................... 334
Figure 235: Front view - 4PP481.1043-75....................................................................... 335
Figure index
Figure 293: Motherboard device configuration ................................................................ 427
Figure 294: Motherboard device configuration - drive configuration ............................... 428
Figure 295: Motherboard device configuration - I/O configuration .................................. 429
Figure 296: Motherboard device configuration - video and flat panel configuration ........ 430
Figure 297: Motherboard device configuration - PCI configuration ................................. 431
Figure 298: Motherboard device configuration - USB configuration................................ 432
Figure 299: Motherboard device configuration - thermal configuration ........................... 433
Figure 300: Memory and cache optimization................................................................... 434
Figure 301: System clock/PLL configuration ................................................................... 435
Figure 302: Power management ..................................................................................... 436
Figure 303: Device information........................................................................................ 437
Figure 304: Miscellaneous configuration ......................................................................... 438
Figure 305: Boot order .................................................................................................... 440
Figure 306: Load defaults................................................................................................ 442
Figure 307: Save values without exit............................................................................... 443
Figure 308: Exit without save .......................................................................................... 443
Figure 309: Save values and exit .................................................................................... 444
Figure 310: Automation Runtime summary screen - ex. 4PP420.1043-75 ..................... 452
Figure 311: Power Panel 300 as an intelligent visualization system ............................... 453
Figure 312: Power Panel 400 with, e.g. Power Panel 300 terminals............................... 454
Figure 313: BIOS upgrade start menu............................................................................. 457
Figure 314: MTCX upgrade start menu ........................................................................... 459
Figure 315: aPCI firmware upgrade start menu .............................................................. 462
Figure 316: User boot logo upgrade start menu.............................................................. 463
Figure 317: Creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP - step 1 .................................. 465
Figure 318: Creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP - step 2 .................................. 465
Figure 319: Creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP - step 3 .................................. 465
Figure 320: Creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP - step 4 .................................. 466
Figure 321: Creating a bootable diskette in Windows XP - step 5 .................................. 466
Figure 322: Creating a USB flash drive for B&R upgrade files........................................ 468
Figure 323: Creating a CompactFlash card for B&R upgrade files ................................. 470
Figure 324: Windows CE logo ......................................................................................... 471
Figure 325: Windows XP embedded Logo ...................................................................... 475
Figure 326: Windows Embedded Standard 2009 Logo................................................... 477
Figure 327: ADI Control Center screenshots (Version 1.50) - example .......................... 481
Figure 328: SDL equalizer setting in the B&R Control Center......................................... 483
Figure 329: Legend strip templates ................................................................................. 511
Figure 330: Temperature humidity diagram - CompactFlash cards 5CFCRD.xxxx-04 ... 516
Figure 331: Dimensions - CompactFlash card Type I ..................................................... 516
Figure 332: ATTO disk benchmark v2.34 comparison (reading)..................................... 517
Figure 333: ATTO disk benchmark v2.34 comparison (writing) ...................................... 517
Figure 334: Temperature humidity diagram - CompactFlash cards 5CFCRD.xxxx-03 ... 520
Figure 335: Dimensions - CompactFlash card Type I ..................................................... 521
Figure 336: Temperature humidity diagram - USB flash drive - 5MMUSB.2048-00........ 524
Figure 337: Null modem cable 9A0017.0x ...................................................................... 525
Figure 338: Pin assignments - null modem cable............................................................ 526
Figure 339: Battery handling ........................................................................................... 529
Figure 340: Temperature humidity diagram - Elo Accu touch screen ............................. 532
Figure 341: Temperature humidity diagram - Gunze touch screen ................................. 534
Figure 342: Viewing angles ............................................................................................. 536
Figure 343: Compatibility details - figure structure .......................................................... 539
Figure 344: Mounting compatibility - 5.7" device format - Horizontal1 ............................ 539
Figure 345: Mounting compatibility - 5.7" device format - Horizontal2 ............................ 540
Figure 346: Mounting compatibility - 5.7" device format - Vertical1 ................................ 540
Figure 347: Mounting compatibility - 10.4" device format - Horizontal1 .......................... 541
Figure 348: Mounting compatibility - 10.4" device format - Horizontal2 .......................... 541
Figure 349: Mounting compatibility - 10.4" device format - Vertical1 .............................. 542
Figure 350: Mounting compatibility - 12.1" device format - Horizontal1 .......................... 543
Figure 351: Mounting compatibility - 15" device format - Horizontal1 ............................. 544
Figure 352: Mounting compatibility - 15" device format - Vertical1 ................................. 544
Figure 353: B&R Key Editor screenshots (Version 3.00) ................................................ 545
Figure 354: ADI development kit screenshots (Version 2.40) ......................................... 547
Table index
Table index
Table 19: Technical data - 5PP320.0571-29....................................................................... 55
Table 20: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.0571-29 .............................................................. 59
Table 21: Technical data - 5PP320.0571-39....................................................................... 61
Table 22: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.0571-39 .............................................................. 65
Table 23: Technical data - 5PP320.0573-39....................................................................... 67
Table 24: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.0573-39 .............................................................. 71
Table 25: Technical data - 5PP320.0573-3B ...................................................................... 73
Table 26: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.0573-3B .............................................................. 77
Table 27: Technical data - 5PP320.1043-39....................................................................... 79
Table 28: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.1043-39 .............................................................. 83
Table 29: Technical data - 5PP320.1214-39....................................................................... 85
Table 30: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.1214-39 .............................................................. 89
Table 31: Technical data - 5PP320.1505-39....................................................................... 91
Table 32: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.1505-39 .............................................................. 95
Table 33: Technical data - 5PP320.1505-3B ...................................................................... 97
Table 34: Contents of delivery - 5PP320.1505-3B ............................................................ 101
Table 35: Pin assignments - COM .................................................................................... 104
Table 36: USB port............................................................................................................ 105
Table 37: Mode/Node switch............................................................................................. 106
Table 38: Switch settings for the Mode / Node switch ...................................................... 106
Table 39: BIOS boot mode switch positions (based on the image) .................................. 107
Table 40: Status LEDs ...................................................................................................... 109
Table 41: Ethernet connection .......................................................................................... 109
Table 42: Power button ..................................................................................................... 110
Table 43: Reset button ...................................................................................................... 110
Table 44: Technical data - 4PP320.0571-01..................................................................... 115
Table 45: Contents of delivery - 4PP320.0571-01 ............................................................ 119
Table 46: Technical data - 4PP320.0571-35..................................................................... 121
Table 47: Contents of delivery - 4PP320.0571-35 ............................................................ 125
Table index
Table 113: Technical data - 4PP452.1043-75..................................................................... 312
Table 114: Contents of delivery - 4PP452.1043-75 ............................................................ 316
Table 115: Technical data - 4PP480.1043-75..................................................................... 318
Table 116: Contents of delivery - 4PP480.1043-75 ............................................................ 322
Table 117: Technical data - 4PP480.1505-75..................................................................... 324
Table 118: Contents of delivery - 4PP480.1505-75 ............................................................ 328
Table 119: Technical data - 4PP480.1505-B5 .................................................................... 330
Table 120: Contents of delivery - 4PP480.1505-B5 ............................................................ 334
Table 121: Technical data - 4PP481.1043-75..................................................................... 336
Table 122: Contents of delivery - 4PP481.1043-75 ............................................................ 340
Table 123: Technical data - 4PP481.1043-B5 .................................................................... 342
Table 124: Contents of delivery - 4PP481.1043-B5 ............................................................ 346
Table 125: Technical data - 4PP481.1505-75..................................................................... 348
Table 126: Contents of delivery - 4PP481.1505-75 ............................................................ 352
Table 127: Technical data - 4PP482.1043-75..................................................................... 354
Table 128: Contents of delivery - 4PP482.1043-75 ............................................................ 358
Table 129: Technical data - Power Panel 420 light............................................................. 359
Table 130: Technical data - Power Panel 420 compact...................................................... 364
Table 131: Technical data - Power Panel 451 light............................................................. 369
Table 132: Technical data - Power Panel 451 compact...................................................... 373
Table 133: Technical data - Power Panel 452 light............................................................. 377
Table 134: Technical data - Power Panel 452 compact...................................................... 381
Table 135: Space for air circulation..................................................................................... 390
Table 136: Mounting orientation 0° ..................................................................................... 391
Table 137: Mounting orientation -45° and +45°. ................................................................. 392
Table 138: BIOS-relevant keys ........................................................................................... 399
Table 139: Overview of BIOS main menu functions ........................................................... 401
Table 140: BIOS motherboard device configuration menu ................................................. 404
Table 141: BIOS drive configuration menu ......................................................................... 405
Table index
Table 207: Test requirements - Shock during transport ...................................................... 495
Table 208: Test requirements - Toppling ............................................................................ 495
Table 209: Test requirements - Toppling ............................................................................ 496
Table 210: Overview of limits and testing guidelines for temperature and humidity ........... 497
Table 211: Test requirements - Worst case during operation ............................................. 497
Table 212: Test requirements - Dry heat ............................................................................ 497
Table 213: Test requirements - Dry cold ............................................................................. 497
Table 214: Test requirements - Large temperature fluctuations ......................................... 498
Table 215: Test requirements - Temperature fluctuations in operation............................... 498
Table 216: Test requirements - Humid heat, cyclic ............................................................. 498
Table 217: Test requirements - Humid heat, constant (storage)......................................... 498
Table 218: Test requirements - Sprayed water (front side)................................................. 499
Table 219: Overview of limits and testing guidelines for safety .......................................... 500
Table 220: Test requirements - Ground resistance............................................................. 500
Table 221: Test requirements - Insulation resistance ......................................................... 500
Table 222: Test requirements - High voltage ...................................................................... 501
Table 223: Test requirements - Voltage range.................................................................... 501
Table 224: Overview of limits and testing guidelines for other tests ................................... 502
Table 225: Test requirements - Protection .......................................................................... 502
Table 226: International certifications ................................................................................. 503
Table 227: Model numbers - Accessories ........................................................................... 505
Table 228: Order data - Lithium batteries ........................................................................... 507
Table 229: Technical data - Lithium batteries ..................................................................... 507
Table 230: Contents of delivery - Lithium batteries ............................................................. 508
Table 231: Order data - TB103 supply plug ........................................................................ 509
Table 232: Technical data - TB103 supply plug .................................................................. 510
Table 233: Contents of delivery - TB103 supply plug ......................................................... 510
Table 234: Order data - Legend strip templates ................................................................. 512
Table 235: Order data - CompactFlash cards ..................................................................... 513
0 5
0AC201.91................................. 37, 505, 507 5AC900.057X-00 ....................... 37, 505, 512
0TB103.9 ................................... 37, 505, 509 5AC900.057X-01 ....................... 37, 505, 512
0TB103.91 ................................. 37, 505, 509 5AC900.104X-00 ....................... 37, 505, 512
5AC900.104X-01 ....................... 38, 505, 512
5AC900.104X-02 ....................... 38, 505, 512
4 5AC900.150X-00 ....................... 38, 505, 512
4A0006.00-000 .......................... 37, 505, 507 5CFCRD.0064-03...................... 38, 505, 518
4PP320.0571-01................................ 31, 114 5CFCRD.0128-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP320.0571-35................................ 31, 120 5CFCRD.016G-04 ..................... 38, 505, 513
4PP320.1043-31................................ 31, 126 5CFCRD.0256-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP320.1505-31................................ 31, 132 5CFCRD.0512-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP351.0571-01................................ 31, 138 5CFCRD.0512-04...................... 38, 505, 513
4PP351.0571-35................................ 31, 144 5CFCRD.1024-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP352.0571-35................................ 31, 150 5CFCRD.1024-04...................... 38, 505, 513
4PP381.1043-31................................ 31, 156 5CFCRD.2048-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP420.0571-45................................ 32, 175 5CFCRD.2048-04...................... 38, 505, 513
4PP420.0571-65................................ 32, 181 5CFCRD.4096-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP420.0571-75................................ 32, 187 5CFCRD.4096-04...................... 38, 505, 513
4PP420.0571-85................................ 32, 193 5CFCRD.8192-03...................... 38, 506, 518
4PP420.0571-A5 ............................... 32, 199 5CFCRD.8192-04...................... 38, 505, 513
4PP420.0571-B5 ............................... 32, 205 5MMUSB.2048-00 ..................... 38, 506, 522
4PP420.0573-75................................ 32, 211 5PP320.0571-29...................................30, 54
4PP420.1043-75................................ 32, 217 5PP320.0571-39...................................30, 60
4PP420.1043-B5 ............................... 32, 223 5PP320.0573-39...................................30, 66
4PP420.1505-75................................ 32, 229 5PP320.0573-3B ..................................30, 72
4PP420.1505-B5 ............................... 33, 235 5PP320.1043-39...................................30, 78
4PP451.0571-45................................ 33, 241 5PP320.1214-39...................................30, 84
4PP451.0571-65................................ 33, 247 5PP320.1505-39...................................30, 90
4PP451.0571-75................................ 33, 253 5PP320.1505-3B ........................................ 96
4PP451.0571-85................................ 33, 260 5SWWCE.0521-ENG .........................36, 471
4PP451.0571-B5 ............................... 33, 266 5SWWCE.0522-ENG .........................37, 471
Model number index
Index
FACT .......................................................452
FIFO .........................................................552
N
Firmware ..................................................553 Node ........................................................ 554
FPGA .......................................................452 Null modem cable .................................... 525
Full speed ..................................45, 105, 166
P
G
PnP .......................................................... 555
GB ............................................................553 POH ......................................................... 555
POST ....................................................... 555
H Power button ............................. 50, 110, 171
Power Panel ............................................ 555
Handshake ...............................................553 Power Panel light / compact
High speed .................................45, 105, 166 Power Panel 420 light / compact .......... 359
Power Panel 451 light / compact .......... 369
I Power Panel 452 light / compact .......... 377
pre calibration .......................................... 393
IDE ...........................................................553 PX32 ........................................................ 452
Image retention ........................................530
Image sticking ..........................................530 Q
Interface ...................................................553
ISO ...........................................................553 QVGA ...................................................... 555
L R
LCD ..........................................................554 RAM ......................................................... 555
LED ..........................................................554 Reset button .............................. 50, 110, 171
Locking time .............................................545 Revision ................................................... 452
Low speed .................................45, 105, 166 ROM ........................................................ 555
RS232 ...................................................... 556
M RTS ......................................................... 556
RXD ......................................................... 556
MAC address ...........................................452
Manual history ...........................................21 S
MB ...........................................................554
Membrane ................................................535 S/N ........................................................... 452
Microprocessor ........................................554 Safety notices ............................................ 25
Mode/Node ..............................................452 Dust, humidity, aggressive gases .......... 27
Mode/Node switch .....................46, 106, 167 Environmentally-friendly disposal ........... 28
Model numbers ..........................................30 Installation .............................................. 27
MS-DOS ..........................................468, 470 Intended use .......................................... 25
MTBF .......................................................554 Operation ............................................... 27
MTCX .........................................................50 Organization ........................................... 29
MTCX Firmware Upgrade ........................459 Policy and procedures ............................ 26
UART .......................................................557
Index